497e80a371
of unnecessary path components that are relics of cvs2svn. (These are directory moves)
7555 lines
274 KiB
Plaintext
7555 lines
274 KiB
Plaintext
@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
|
|
@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
|
@c This is part of the GCC manual.
|
|
@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Machine Desc
|
|
@chapter Machine Descriptions
|
|
@cindex machine descriptions
|
|
|
|
A machine description has two parts: a file of instruction patterns
|
|
(@file{.md} file) and a C header file of macro definitions.
|
|
|
|
The @file{.md} file for a target machine contains a pattern for each
|
|
instruction that the target machine supports (or at least each instruction
|
|
that is worth telling the compiler about). It may also contain comments.
|
|
A semicolon causes the rest of the line to be a comment, unless the semicolon
|
|
is inside a quoted string.
|
|
|
|
See the next chapter for information on the C header file.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Overview:: How the machine description is used.
|
|
* Patterns:: How to write instruction patterns.
|
|
* Example:: An explained example of a @code{define_insn} pattern.
|
|
* RTL Template:: The RTL template defines what insns match a pattern.
|
|
* Output Template:: The output template says how to make assembler code
|
|
from such an insn.
|
|
* Output Statement:: For more generality, write C code to output
|
|
the assembler code.
|
|
* Predicates:: Controlling what kinds of operands can be used
|
|
for an insn.
|
|
* Constraints:: Fine-tuning operand selection.
|
|
* Standard Names:: Names mark patterns to use for code generation.
|
|
* Pattern Ordering:: When the order of patterns makes a difference.
|
|
* Dependent Patterns:: Having one pattern may make you need another.
|
|
* Jump Patterns:: Special considerations for patterns for jump insns.
|
|
* Looping Patterns:: How to define patterns for special looping insns.
|
|
* Insn Canonicalizations::Canonicalization of Instructions
|
|
* Expander Definitions::Generating a sequence of several RTL insns
|
|
for a standard operation.
|
|
* Insn Splitting:: Splitting Instructions into Multiple Instructions.
|
|
* Including Patterns:: Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
|
|
* Peephole Definitions::Defining machine-specific peephole optimizations.
|
|
* Insn Attributes:: Specifying the value of attributes for generated insns.
|
|
* Conditional Execution::Generating @code{define_insn} patterns for
|
|
predication.
|
|
* Constant Definitions::Defining symbolic constants that can be used in the
|
|
md file.
|
|
* Macros:: Using macros to generate patterns from a template.
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Overview
|
|
@section Overview of How the Machine Description is Used
|
|
|
|
There are three main conversions that happen in the compiler:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The front end reads the source code and builds a parse tree.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The parse tree is used to generate an RTL insn list based on named
|
|
instruction patterns.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The insn list is matched against the RTL templates to produce assembler
|
|
code.
|
|
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
For the generate pass, only the names of the insns matter, from either a
|
|
named @code{define_insn} or a @code{define_expand}. The compiler will
|
|
choose the pattern with the right name and apply the operands according
|
|
to the documentation later in this chapter, without regard for the RTL
|
|
template or operand constraints. Note that the names the compiler looks
|
|
for are hard-coded in the compiler---it will ignore unnamed patterns and
|
|
patterns with names it doesn't know about, but if you don't provide a
|
|
named pattern it needs, it will abort.
|
|
|
|
If a @code{define_insn} is used, the template given is inserted into the
|
|
insn list. If a @code{define_expand} is used, one of three things
|
|
happens, based on the condition logic. The condition logic may manually
|
|
create new insns for the insn list, say via @code{emit_insn()}, and
|
|
invoke @code{DONE}. For certain named patterns, it may invoke @code{FAIL} to tell the
|
|
compiler to use an alternate way of performing that task. If it invokes
|
|
neither @code{DONE} nor @code{FAIL}, the template given in the pattern
|
|
is inserted, as if the @code{define_expand} were a @code{define_insn}.
|
|
|
|
Once the insn list is generated, various optimization passes convert,
|
|
replace, and rearrange the insns in the insn list. This is where the
|
|
@code{define_split} and @code{define_peephole} patterns get used, for
|
|
example.
|
|
|
|
Finally, the insn list's RTL is matched up with the RTL templates in the
|
|
@code{define_insn} patterns, and those patterns are used to emit the
|
|
final assembly code. For this purpose, each named @code{define_insn}
|
|
acts like it's unnamed, since the names are ignored.
|
|
|
|
@node Patterns
|
|
@section Everything about Instruction Patterns
|
|
@cindex patterns
|
|
@cindex instruction patterns
|
|
|
|
@findex define_insn
|
|
Each instruction pattern contains an incomplete RTL expression, with pieces
|
|
to be filled in later, operand constraints that restrict how the pieces can
|
|
be filled in, and an output pattern or C code to generate the assembler
|
|
output, all wrapped up in a @code{define_insn} expression.
|
|
|
|
A @code{define_insn} is an RTL expression containing four or five operands:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
An optional name. The presence of a name indicate that this instruction
|
|
pattern can perform a certain standard job for the RTL-generation
|
|
pass of the compiler. This pass knows certain names and will use
|
|
the instruction patterns with those names, if the names are defined
|
|
in the machine description.
|
|
|
|
The absence of a name is indicated by writing an empty string
|
|
where the name should go. Nameless instruction patterns are never
|
|
used for generating RTL code, but they may permit several simpler insns
|
|
to be combined later on.
|
|
|
|
Names that are not thus known and used in RTL-generation have no
|
|
effect; they are equivalent to no name at all.
|
|
|
|
For the purpose of debugging the compiler, you may also specify a
|
|
name beginning with the @samp{*} character. Such a name is used only
|
|
for identifying the instruction in RTL dumps; it is entirely equivalent
|
|
to having a nameless pattern for all other purposes.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The @dfn{RTL template} (@pxref{RTL Template}) is a vector of incomplete
|
|
RTL expressions which show what the instruction should look like. It is
|
|
incomplete because it may contain @code{match_operand},
|
|
@code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup} expressions that stand for
|
|
operands of the instruction.
|
|
|
|
If the vector has only one element, that element is the template for the
|
|
instruction pattern. If the vector has multiple elements, then the
|
|
instruction pattern is a @code{parallel} expression containing the
|
|
elements described.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@cindex pattern conditions
|
|
@cindex conditions, in patterns
|
|
A condition. This is a string which contains a C expression that is
|
|
the final test to decide whether an insn body matches this pattern.
|
|
|
|
@cindex named patterns and conditions
|
|
For a named pattern, the condition (if present) may not depend on
|
|
the data in the insn being matched, but only the target-machine-type
|
|
flags. The compiler needs to test these conditions during
|
|
initialization in order to learn exactly which named instructions are
|
|
available in a particular run.
|
|
|
|
@findex operands
|
|
For nameless patterns, the condition is applied only when matching an
|
|
individual insn, and only after the insn has matched the pattern's
|
|
recognition template. The insn's operands may be found in the vector
|
|
@code{operands}. For an insn where the condition has once matched, it
|
|
can't be used to control register allocation, for example by excluding
|
|
certain hard registers or hard register combinations.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The @dfn{output template}: a string that says how to output matching
|
|
insns as assembler code. @samp{%} in this string specifies where
|
|
to substitute the value of an operand. @xref{Output Template}.
|
|
|
|
When simple substitution isn't general enough, you can specify a piece
|
|
of C code to compute the output. @xref{Output Statement}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
Optionally, a vector containing the values of attributes for insns matching
|
|
this pattern. @xref{Insn Attributes}.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@node Example
|
|
@section Example of @code{define_insn}
|
|
@cindex @code{define_insn} example
|
|
|
|
Here is an actual example of an instruction pattern, for the 68000/68020.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "tstsi"
|
|
[(set (cc0)
|
|
(match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
|
|
""
|
|
"*
|
|
@{
|
|
if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
|
|
return \"tstl %0\";
|
|
return \"cmpl #0,%0\";
|
|
@}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
This can also be written using braced strings:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "tstsi"
|
|
[(set (cc0)
|
|
(match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
|
|
""
|
|
@{
|
|
if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
|
|
return "tstl %0";
|
|
return "cmpl #0,%0";
|
|
@})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
This is an instruction that sets the condition codes based on the value of
|
|
a general operand. It has no condition, so any insn whose RTL description
|
|
has the form shown may be handled according to this pattern. The name
|
|
@samp{tstsi} means ``test a @code{SImode} value'' and tells the RTL generation
|
|
pass that, when it is necessary to test such a value, an insn to do so
|
|
can be constructed using this pattern.
|
|
|
|
The output control string is a piece of C code which chooses which
|
|
output template to return based on the kind of operand and the specific
|
|
type of CPU for which code is being generated.
|
|
|
|
@samp{"rm"} is an operand constraint. Its meaning is explained below.
|
|
|
|
@node RTL Template
|
|
@section RTL Template
|
|
@cindex RTL insn template
|
|
@cindex generating insns
|
|
@cindex insns, generating
|
|
@cindex recognizing insns
|
|
@cindex insns, recognizing
|
|
|
|
The RTL template is used to define which insns match the particular pattern
|
|
and how to find their operands. For named patterns, the RTL template also
|
|
says how to construct an insn from specified operands.
|
|
|
|
Construction involves substituting specified operands into a copy of the
|
|
template. Matching involves determining the values that serve as the
|
|
operands in the insn being matched. Both of these activities are
|
|
controlled by special expression types that direct matching and
|
|
substitution of the operands.
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@findex match_operand
|
|
@item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} @var{constraint})
|
|
This expression is a placeholder for operand number @var{n} of
|
|
the insn. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n}
|
|
will be substituted at this point. When matching an insn, whatever
|
|
appears at this position in the insn will be taken as operand
|
|
number @var{n}; but it must satisfy @var{predicate} or this instruction
|
|
pattern will not match at all.
|
|
|
|
Operand numbers must be chosen consecutively counting from zero in
|
|
each instruction pattern. There may be only one @code{match_operand}
|
|
expression in the pattern for each operand number. Usually operands
|
|
are numbered in the order of appearance in @code{match_operand}
|
|
expressions. In the case of a @code{define_expand}, any operand numbers
|
|
used only in @code{match_dup} expressions have higher values than all
|
|
other operand numbers.
|
|
|
|
@var{predicate} is a string that is the name of a function that
|
|
accepts two arguments, an expression and a machine mode.
|
|
@xref{Predicates}. During matching, the function will be called with
|
|
the putative operand as the expression and @var{m} as the mode
|
|
argument (if @var{m} is not specified, @code{VOIDmode} will be used,
|
|
which normally causes @var{predicate} to accept any mode). If it
|
|
returns zero, this instruction pattern fails to match.
|
|
@var{predicate} may be an empty string; then it means no test is to be
|
|
done on the operand, so anything which occurs in this position is
|
|
valid.
|
|
|
|
Most of the time, @var{predicate} will reject modes other than @var{m}---but
|
|
not always. For example, the predicate @code{address_operand} uses
|
|
@var{m} as the mode of memory ref that the address should be valid for.
|
|
Many predicates accept @code{const_int} nodes even though their mode is
|
|
@code{VOIDmode}.
|
|
|
|
@var{constraint} controls reloading and the choice of the best register
|
|
class to use for a value, as explained later (@pxref{Constraints}).
|
|
If the constraint would be an empty string, it can be omitted.
|
|
|
|
People are often unclear on the difference between the constraint and the
|
|
predicate. The predicate helps decide whether a given insn matches the
|
|
pattern. The constraint plays no role in this decision; instead, it
|
|
controls various decisions in the case of an insn which does match.
|
|
|
|
@findex match_scratch
|
|
@item (match_scratch:@var{m} @var{n} @var{constraint})
|
|
This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}
|
|
and indicates that operand must be a @code{scratch} or @code{reg}
|
|
expression.
|
|
|
|
When matching patterns, this is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} "scratch_operand" @var{pred})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
but, when generating RTL, it produces a (@code{scratch}:@var{m})
|
|
expression.
|
|
|
|
If the last few expressions in a @code{parallel} are @code{clobber}
|
|
expressions whose operands are either a hard register or
|
|
@code{match_scratch}, the combiner can add or delete them when
|
|
necessary. @xref{Side Effects}.
|
|
|
|
@findex match_dup
|
|
@item (match_dup @var{n})
|
|
This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}.
|
|
It is used when the operand needs to appear more than once in the
|
|
insn.
|
|
|
|
In construction, @code{match_dup} acts just like @code{match_operand}:
|
|
the operand is substituted into the insn being constructed. But in
|
|
matching, @code{match_dup} behaves differently. It assumes that operand
|
|
number @var{n} has already been determined by a @code{match_operand}
|
|
appearing earlier in the recognition template, and it matches only an
|
|
identical-looking expression.
|
|
|
|
Note that @code{match_dup} should not be used to tell the compiler that
|
|
a particular register is being used for two operands (example:
|
|
@code{add} that adds one register to another; the second register is
|
|
both an input operand and the output operand). Use a matching
|
|
constraint (@pxref{Simple Constraints}) for those. @code{match_dup} is for the cases where one
|
|
operand is used in two places in the template, such as an instruction
|
|
that computes both a quotient and a remainder, where the opcode takes
|
|
two input operands but the RTL template has to refer to each of those
|
|
twice; once for the quotient pattern and once for the remainder pattern.
|
|
|
|
@findex match_operator
|
|
@item (match_operator:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{operands}@dots{}])
|
|
This pattern is a kind of placeholder for a variable RTL expression
|
|
code.
|
|
|
|
When constructing an insn, it stands for an RTL expression whose
|
|
expression code is taken from that of operand @var{n}, and whose
|
|
operands are constructed from the patterns @var{operands}.
|
|
|
|
When matching an expression, it matches an expression if the function
|
|
@var{predicate} returns nonzero on that expression @emph{and} the
|
|
patterns @var{operands} match the operands of the expression.
|
|
|
|
Suppose that the function @code{commutative_operator} is defined as
|
|
follows, to match any expression whose operator is one of the
|
|
commutative arithmetic operators of RTL and whose mode is @var{mode}:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
int
|
|
commutative_integer_operator (x, mode)
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
enum machine_mode mode;
|
|
@{
|
|
enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
|
|
if (GET_MODE (x) != mode)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
return (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == RTX_COMM_ARITH
|
|
|| code == EQ || code == NE);
|
|
@}
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Then the following pattern will match any RTL expression consisting
|
|
of a commutative operator applied to two general operands:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(match_operator:SI 3 "commutative_operator"
|
|
[(match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "g")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Here the vector @code{[@var{operands}@dots{}]} contains two patterns
|
|
because the expressions to be matched all contain two operands.
|
|
|
|
When this pattern does match, the two operands of the commutative
|
|
operator are recorded as operands 1 and 2 of the insn. (This is done
|
|
by the two instances of @code{match_operand}.) Operand 3 of the insn
|
|
will be the entire commutative expression: use @code{GET_CODE
|
|
(operands[3])} to see which commutative operator was used.
|
|
|
|
The machine mode @var{m} of @code{match_operator} works like that of
|
|
@code{match_operand}: it is passed as the second argument to the
|
|
predicate function, and that function is solely responsible for
|
|
deciding whether the expression to be matched ``has'' that mode.
|
|
|
|
When constructing an insn, argument 3 of the gen-function will specify
|
|
the operation (i.e.@: the expression code) for the expression to be
|
|
made. It should be an RTL expression, whose expression code is copied
|
|
into a new expression whose operands are arguments 1 and 2 of the
|
|
gen-function. The subexpressions of argument 3 are not used;
|
|
only its expression code matters.
|
|
|
|
When @code{match_operator} is used in a pattern for matching an insn,
|
|
it usually best if the operand number of the @code{match_operator}
|
|
is higher than that of the actual operands of the insn. This improves
|
|
register allocation because the register allocator often looks at
|
|
operands 1 and 2 of insns to see if it can do register tying.
|
|
|
|
There is no way to specify constraints in @code{match_operator}. The
|
|
operand of the insn which corresponds to the @code{match_operator}
|
|
never has any constraints because it is never reloaded as a whole.
|
|
However, if parts of its @var{operands} are matched by
|
|
@code{match_operand} patterns, those parts may have constraints of
|
|
their own.
|
|
|
|
@findex match_op_dup
|
|
@item (match_op_dup:@var{m} @var{n}[@var{operands}@dots{}])
|
|
Like @code{match_dup}, except that it applies to operators instead of
|
|
operands. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be
|
|
substituted at this point. But in matching, @code{match_op_dup} behaves
|
|
differently. It assumes that operand number @var{n} has already been
|
|
determined by a @code{match_operator} appearing earlier in the
|
|
recognition template, and it matches only an identical-looking
|
|
expression.
|
|
|
|
@findex match_parallel
|
|
@item (match_parallel @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
|
|
This pattern is a placeholder for an insn that consists of a
|
|
@code{parallel} expression with a variable number of elements. This
|
|
expression should only appear at the top level of an insn pattern.
|
|
|
|
When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be substituted at
|
|
this point. When matching an insn, it matches if the body of the insn
|
|
is a @code{parallel} expression with at least as many elements as the
|
|
vector of @var{subpat} expressions in the @code{match_parallel}, if each
|
|
@var{subpat} matches the corresponding element of the @code{parallel},
|
|
@emph{and} the function @var{predicate} returns nonzero on the
|
|
@code{parallel} that is the body of the insn. It is the responsibility
|
|
of the predicate to validate elements of the @code{parallel} beyond
|
|
those listed in the @code{match_parallel}.
|
|
|
|
A typical use of @code{match_parallel} is to match load and store
|
|
multiple expressions, which can contain a variable number of elements
|
|
in a @code{parallel}. For example,
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
|
|
(use (reg:SI 179))
|
|
(clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
|
|
""
|
|
"loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
This example comes from @file{a29k.md}. The function
|
|
@code{load_multiple_operation} is defined in @file{a29k.c} and checks
|
|
that subsequent elements in the @code{parallel} are the same as the
|
|
@code{set} in the pattern, except that they are referencing subsequent
|
|
registers and memory locations.
|
|
|
|
An insn that matches this pattern might look like:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(parallel
|
|
[(set (reg:SI 20) (mem:SI (reg:SI 100)))
|
|
(use (reg:SI 179))
|
|
(clobber (reg:SI 179))
|
|
(set (reg:SI 21)
|
|
(mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
|
|
(const_int 4))))
|
|
(set (reg:SI 22)
|
|
(mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
|
|
(const_int 8))))])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@findex match_par_dup
|
|
@item (match_par_dup @var{n} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
|
|
Like @code{match_op_dup}, but for @code{match_parallel} instead of
|
|
@code{match_operator}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Output Template
|
|
@section Output Templates and Operand Substitution
|
|
@cindex output templates
|
|
@cindex operand substitution
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{%} in template
|
|
@cindex percent sign
|
|
The @dfn{output template} is a string which specifies how to output the
|
|
assembler code for an instruction pattern. Most of the template is a
|
|
fixed string which is output literally. The character @samp{%} is used
|
|
to specify where to substitute an operand; it can also be used to
|
|
identify places where different variants of the assembler require
|
|
different syntax.
|
|
|
|
In the simplest case, a @samp{%} followed by a digit @var{n} says to output
|
|
operand @var{n} at that point in the string.
|
|
|
|
@samp{%} followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
|
|
alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings described
|
|
below. The machine description macro @code{PRINT_OPERAND} can define
|
|
additional letters with nonstandard meanings.
|
|
|
|
@samp{%c@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand that is a
|
|
constant value without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate
|
|
operand.
|
|
|
|
@samp{%n@var{digit}} is like @samp{%c@var{digit}} except that the value of
|
|
the constant is negated before printing.
|
|
|
|
@samp{%a@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a
|
|
memory reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may
|
|
be useful when outputting a ``load address'' instruction, because often the
|
|
assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
|
|
as if it were a memory reference.
|
|
|
|
@samp{%l@var{digit}} is used to substitute a @code{label_ref} into a jump
|
|
instruction.
|
|
|
|
@samp{%=} outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the
|
|
entire compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be
|
|
referred to more than once in a single template that generates multiple
|
|
assembler instructions.
|
|
|
|
@samp{%} followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that
|
|
does not use an operand. Only one case is standard: @samp{%%} outputs a
|
|
@samp{%} into the assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be
|
|
defined in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. You must also define
|
|
which punctuation characters are valid with the
|
|
@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} macro.
|
|
|
|
@cindex \
|
|
@cindex backslash
|
|
The template may generate multiple assembler instructions. Write the text
|
|
for the instructions, with @samp{\;} between them.
|
|
|
|
@cindex matching operands
|
|
When the RTL contains two operands which are required by constraint to match
|
|
each other, the output template must refer only to the lower-numbered operand.
|
|
Matching operands are not always identical, and the rest of the compiler
|
|
arranges to put the proper RTL expression for printing into the lower-numbered
|
|
operand.
|
|
|
|
One use of nonstandard letters or punctuation following @samp{%} is to
|
|
distinguish between different assembler languages for the same machine; for
|
|
example, Motorola syntax versus MIT syntax for the 68000. Motorola syntax
|
|
requires periods in most opcode names, while MIT syntax does not. For
|
|
example, the opcode @samp{movel} in MIT syntax is @samp{move.l} in Motorola
|
|
syntax. The same file of patterns is used for both kinds of output syntax,
|
|
but the character sequence @samp{%.} is used in each place where Motorola
|
|
syntax wants a period. The @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro for Motorola syntax
|
|
defines the sequence to output a period; the macro for MIT syntax defines
|
|
it to do nothing.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{#} in template
|
|
As a special case, a template consisting of the single character @code{#}
|
|
instructs the compiler to first split the insn, and then output the
|
|
resulting instructions separately. This helps eliminate redundancy in the
|
|
output templates. If you have a @code{define_insn} that needs to emit
|
|
multiple assembler instructions, and there is an matching @code{define_split}
|
|
already defined, then you can simply use @code{#} as the output template
|
|
instead of writing an output template that emits the multiple assembler
|
|
instructions.
|
|
|
|
If the macro @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is defined, you can use construct
|
|
of the form @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@}} in the templates. These
|
|
describe multiple variants of assembler language syntax.
|
|
@xref{Instruction Output}.
|
|
|
|
@node Output Statement
|
|
@section C Statements for Assembler Output
|
|
@cindex output statements
|
|
@cindex C statements for assembler output
|
|
@cindex generating assembler output
|
|
|
|
Often a single fixed template string cannot produce correct and efficient
|
|
assembler code for all the cases that are recognized by a single
|
|
instruction pattern. For example, the opcodes may depend on the kinds of
|
|
operands; or some unfortunate combinations of operands may require extra
|
|
machine instructions.
|
|
|
|
If the output control string starts with a @samp{@@}, then it is actually
|
|
a series of templates, each on a separate line. (Blank lines and
|
|
leading spaces and tabs are ignored.) The templates correspond to the
|
|
pattern's constraint alternatives (@pxref{Multi-Alternative}). For example,
|
|
if a target machine has a two-address add instruction @samp{addr} to add
|
|
into a register and another @samp{addm} to add a register to memory, you
|
|
might write this pattern:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "addsi3"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
|
|
(plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0,0")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g,r")))]
|
|
""
|
|
"@@
|
|
addr %2,%0
|
|
addm %2,%0")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{*} in template
|
|
@cindex asterisk in template
|
|
If the output control string starts with a @samp{*}, then it is not an
|
|
output template but rather a piece of C program that should compute a
|
|
template. It should execute a @code{return} statement to return the
|
|
template-string you want. Most such templates use C string literals, which
|
|
require doublequote characters to delimit them. To include these
|
|
doublequote characters in the string, prefix each one with @samp{\}.
|
|
|
|
If the output control string is written as a brace block instead of a
|
|
double-quoted string, it is automatically assumed to be C code. In that
|
|
case, it is not necessary to put in a leading asterisk, or to escape the
|
|
doublequotes surrounding C string literals.
|
|
|
|
The operands may be found in the array @code{operands}, whose C data type
|
|
is @code{rtx []}.
|
|
|
|
It is very common to select different ways of generating assembler code
|
|
based on whether an immediate operand is within a certain range. Be
|
|
careful when doing this, because the result of @code{INTVAL} is an
|
|
integer on the host machine. If the host machine has more bits in an
|
|
@code{int} than the target machine has in the mode in which the constant
|
|
will be used, then some of the bits you get from @code{INTVAL} will be
|
|
superfluous. For proper results, you must carefully disregard the
|
|
values of those bits.
|
|
|
|
@findex output_asm_insn
|
|
It is possible to output an assembler instruction and then go on to output
|
|
or compute more of them, using the subroutine @code{output_asm_insn}. This
|
|
receives two arguments: a template-string and a vector of operands. The
|
|
vector may be @code{operands}, or it may be another array of @code{rtx}
|
|
that you declare locally and initialize yourself.
|
|
|
|
@findex which_alternative
|
|
When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
|
|
the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which alternative
|
|
was matched. When this is so, the C code can test the variable
|
|
@code{which_alternative}, which is the ordinal number of the alternative
|
|
that was actually satisfied (0 for the first, 1 for the second alternative,
|
|
etc.).
|
|
|
|
For example, suppose there are two opcodes for storing zero, @samp{clrreg}
|
|
for registers and @samp{clrmem} for memory locations. Here is how
|
|
a pattern could use @code{which_alternative} to choose between them:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
|
|
(const_int 0))]
|
|
""
|
|
@{
|
|
return (which_alternative == 0
|
|
? "clrreg %0" : "clrmem %0");
|
|
@})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The example above, where the assembler code to generate was
|
|
@emph{solely} determined by the alternative, could also have been specified
|
|
as follows, having the output control string start with a @samp{@@}:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
|
|
(const_int 0))]
|
|
""
|
|
"@@
|
|
clrreg %0
|
|
clrmem %0")
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@node Predicates
|
|
@section Predicates
|
|
@cindex predicates
|
|
@cindex operand predicates
|
|
@cindex operator predicates
|
|
|
|
A predicate determines whether a @code{match_operand} or
|
|
@code{match_operator} expression matches, and therefore whether the
|
|
surrounding instruction pattern will be used for that combination of
|
|
operands. GCC has a number of machine-independent predicates, and you
|
|
can define machine-specific predicates as needed. By convention,
|
|
predicates used with @code{match_operand} have names that end in
|
|
@samp{_operand}, and those used with @code{match_operator} have names
|
|
that end in @samp{_operator}.
|
|
|
|
All predicates are Boolean functions (in the mathematical sense) of
|
|
two arguments: the RTL expression that is being considered at that
|
|
position in the instruction pattern, and the machine mode that the
|
|
@code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} specifies. In this
|
|
section, the first argument is called @var{op} and the second argument
|
|
@var{mode}. Predicates can be called from C as ordinary two-argument
|
|
functions; this can be useful in output templates or other
|
|
machine-specific code.
|
|
|
|
Operand predicates can allow operands that are not actually acceptable
|
|
to the hardware, as long as the constraints give reload the ability to
|
|
fix them up (@pxref{Constraints}). However, GCC will usually generate
|
|
better code if the predicates specify the requirements of the machine
|
|
instructions as closely as possible. Reload cannot fix up operands
|
|
that must be constants (``immediate operands''); you must use a
|
|
predicate that allows only constants, or else enforce the requirement
|
|
in the extra condition.
|
|
|
|
@cindex predicates and machine modes
|
|
@cindex normal predicates
|
|
@cindex special predicates
|
|
Most predicates handle their @var{mode} argument in a uniform manner.
|
|
If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode} (unspecified), then @var{op} can have
|
|
any mode. If @var{mode} is anything else, then @var{op} must have the
|
|
same mode, unless @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or integer
|
|
@code{CONST_DOUBLE}. These RTL expressions always have
|
|
@code{VOIDmode}, so it would be counterproductive to check that their
|
|
mode matches. Instead, predicates that accept @code{CONST_INT} and/or
|
|
integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE} check that the value stored in the
|
|
constant will fit in the requested mode.
|
|
|
|
Predicates with this behavior are called @dfn{normal}.
|
|
@command{genrecog} can optimize the instruction recognizer based on
|
|
knowledge of how normal predicates treat modes. It can also diagnose
|
|
certain kinds of common errors in the use of normal predicates; for
|
|
instance, it is almost always an error to use a normal predicate
|
|
without specifying a mode.
|
|
|
|
Predicates that do something different with their @var{mode} argument
|
|
are called @dfn{special}. The generic predicates
|
|
@code{address_operand} and @code{pmode_register_operand} are special
|
|
predicates. @command{genrecog} does not do any optimizations or
|
|
diagnosis when special predicates are used.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Machine-Independent Predicates:: Predicates available to all back ends.
|
|
* Defining Predicates:: How to write machine-specific predicate
|
|
functions.
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Machine-Independent Predicates
|
|
@subsection Machine-Independent Predicates
|
|
@cindex machine-independent predicates
|
|
@cindex generic predicates
|
|
|
|
These are the generic predicates available to all back ends. They are
|
|
defined in @file{recog.c}. The first category of predicates allow
|
|
only constant, or @dfn{immediate}, operands.
|
|
|
|
@defun immediate_operand
|
|
This predicate allows any sort of constant that fits in @var{mode}.
|
|
It is an appropriate choice for instructions that take operands that
|
|
must be constant.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun const_int_operand
|
|
This predicate allows any @code{CONST_INT} expression that fits in
|
|
@var{mode}. It is an appropriate choice for an immediate operand that
|
|
does not allow a symbol or label.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun const_double_operand
|
|
This predicate accepts any @code{CONST_DOUBLE} expression that has
|
|
exactly @var{mode}. If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, it will also
|
|
accept @code{CONST_INT}. It is intended for immediate floating point
|
|
constants.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The second category of predicates allow only some kind of machine
|
|
register.
|
|
|
|
@defun register_operand
|
|
This predicate allows any @code{REG} or @code{SUBREG} expression that
|
|
is valid for @var{mode}. It is often suitable for arithmetic
|
|
instruction operands on a RISC machine.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun pmode_register_operand
|
|
This is a slight variant on @code{register_operand} which works around
|
|
a limitation in the machine-description reader.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(match_operand @var{n} "pmode_register_operand" @var{constraint})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
means exactly what
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(match_operand:P @var{n} "register_operand" @var{constraint})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
would mean, if the machine-description reader accepted @samp{:P}
|
|
mode suffixes. Unfortunately, it cannot, because @code{Pmode} is an
|
|
alias for some other mode, and might vary with machine-specific
|
|
options. @xref{Misc}.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun scratch_operand
|
|
This predicate allows hard registers and @code{SCRATCH} expressions,
|
|
but not pseudo-registers. It is used internally by @code{match_scratch};
|
|
it should not be used directly.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The third category of predicates allow only some kind of memory reference.
|
|
|
|
@defun memory_operand
|
|
This predicate allows any valid reference to a quantity of mode
|
|
@var{mode} in memory, as determined by the weak form of
|
|
@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} (@pxref{Addressing Modes}).
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun address_operand
|
|
This predicate is a little unusual; it allows any operand that is a
|
|
valid expression for the @emph{address} of a quantity of mode
|
|
@var{mode}, again determined by the weak form of
|
|
@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}. To first order, if
|
|
@samp{@w{(mem:@var{mode} (@var{exp}))}} is acceptable to
|
|
@code{memory_operand}, then @var{exp} is acceptable to
|
|
@code{address_operand}. Note that @var{exp} does not necessarily have
|
|
the mode @var{mode}.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun indirect_operand
|
|
This is a stricter form of @code{memory_operand} which allows only
|
|
memory references with a @code{general_operand} as the address
|
|
expression. New uses of this predicate are discouraged, because
|
|
@code{general_operand} is very permissive, so it's hard to tell what
|
|
an @code{indirect_operand} does or does not allow. If a target has
|
|
different requirements for memory operands for different instructions,
|
|
it is better to define target-specific predicates which enforce the
|
|
hardware's requirements explicitly.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun push_operand
|
|
This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for pushing a value
|
|
onto the stack. This will be a @code{MEM} which refers to
|
|
@code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side-effect in its address expression
|
|
(@pxref{Incdec}); which one is determined by the
|
|
@code{STACK_PUSH_CODE} macro (@pxref{Frame Layout}).
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun pop_operand
|
|
This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for popping a value
|
|
off the stack. Again, this will be a @code{MEM} referring to
|
|
@code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side-effect in its address
|
|
expression. However, this time @code{STACK_POP_CODE} is expected.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The fourth category of predicates allow some combination of the above
|
|
operands.
|
|
|
|
@defun nonmemory_operand
|
|
This predicate allows any immediate or register operand valid for @var{mode}.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun nonimmediate_operand
|
|
This predicate allows any register or memory operand valid for @var{mode}.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun general_operand
|
|
This predicate allows any immediate, register, or memory operand
|
|
valid for @var{mode}.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Finally, there is one generic operator predicate.
|
|
|
|
@defun comparison_operator
|
|
This predicate matches any expression which performs an arithmetic
|
|
comparison in @var{mode}; that is, @code{COMPARISON_P} is true for the
|
|
expression code.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@node Defining Predicates
|
|
@subsection Defining Machine-Specific Predicates
|
|
@cindex defining predicates
|
|
@findex define_predicate
|
|
@findex define_special_predicate
|
|
|
|
Many machines have requirements for their operands that cannot be
|
|
expressed precisely using the generic predicates. You can define
|
|
additional predicates using @code{define_predicate} and
|
|
@code{define_special_predicate} expressions. These expressions have
|
|
three operands:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
The name of the predicate, as it will be referred to in
|
|
@code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} expressions.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
An RTL expression which evaluates to true if the predicate allows the
|
|
operand @var{op}, false if it does not. This expression can only use
|
|
the following RTL codes:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item MATCH_OPERAND
|
|
When written inside a predicate expression, a @code{MATCH_OPERAND}
|
|
expression evaluates to true if the predicate it names would allow
|
|
@var{op}. The operand number and constraint are ignored. Due to
|
|
limitations in @command{genrecog}, you can only refer to generic
|
|
predicates and predicates that have already been defined.
|
|
|
|
@item MATCH_CODE
|
|
This expression evaluates to true if @var{op} or a specified
|
|
subexpression of @var{op} has one of a given list of RTX codes.
|
|
|
|
The first operand of this expression is a string constant containing a
|
|
comma-separated list of RTX code names (in lower case). These are the
|
|
codes for which the @code{MATCH_CODE} will be true.
|
|
|
|
The second operand is a string constant which indicates what
|
|
subexpression of @var{op} to examine. If it is absent or the empty
|
|
string, @var{op} itself is examined. Otherwise, the string constant
|
|
must be a sequence of digits and/or lowercase letters. Each character
|
|
indicates a subexpression to extract from the current expression; for
|
|
the first character this is @var{op}, for the second and subsequent
|
|
characters it is the result of the previous character. A digit
|
|
@var{n} extracts @samp{@w{XEXP (@var{e}, @var{n})}}; a letter @var{l}
|
|
extracts @samp{@w{XVECEXP (@var{e}, 0, @var{n})}} where @var{n} is the
|
|
alphabetic ordinal of @var{l} (0 for `a', 1 for 'b', and so on). The
|
|
@code{MATCH_CODE} then examines the RTX code of the subexpression
|
|
extracted by the complete string. It is not possible to extract
|
|
components of an @code{rtvec} that is not at position 0 within its RTX
|
|
object.
|
|
|
|
@item MATCH_TEST
|
|
This expression has one operand, a string constant containing a C
|
|
expression. The predicate's arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
|
|
available with those names in the C expression. The @code{MATCH_TEST}
|
|
evaluates to true if the C expression evaluates to a nonzero value.
|
|
@code{MATCH_TEST} expressions must not have side effects.
|
|
|
|
@item AND
|
|
@itemx IOR
|
|
@itemx NOT
|
|
@itemx IF_THEN_ELSE
|
|
The basic @samp{MATCH_} expressions can be combined using these
|
|
logical operators, which have the semantics of the C operators
|
|
@samp{&&}, @samp{||}, @samp{!}, and @samp{@w{? :}} respectively. As
|
|
in Common Lisp, you may give an @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expression an
|
|
arbitrary number of arguments; this has exactly the same effect as
|
|
writing a chain of two-argument @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expressions.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
An optional block of C code, which should execute
|
|
@samp{@w{return true}} if the predicate is found to match and
|
|
@samp{@w{return false}} if it does not. It must not have any side
|
|
effects. The predicate arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
|
|
available with those names.
|
|
|
|
If a code block is present in a predicate definition, then the RTL
|
|
expression must evaluate to true @emph{and} the code block must
|
|
execute @samp{@w{return true}} for the predicate to allow the operand.
|
|
The RTL expression is evaluated first; do not re-check anything in the
|
|
code block that was checked in the RTL expression.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The program @command{genrecog} scans @code{define_predicate} and
|
|
@code{define_special_predicate} expressions to determine which RTX
|
|
codes are possibly allowed. You should always make this explicit in
|
|
the RTL predicate expression, using @code{MATCH_OPERAND} and
|
|
@code{MATCH_CODE}.
|
|
|
|
Here is an example of a simple predicate definition, from the IA64
|
|
machine description:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
;; @r{True if @var{op} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} which refers to the sdata section.}
|
|
(define_predicate "small_addr_symbolic_operand"
|
|
(and (match_code "symbol_ref")
|
|
(match_test "SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_ADDR_P (op)")))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
And here is another, showing the use of the C block.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
;; @r{True if @var{op} is a register operand that is (or could be) a GR reg.}
|
|
(define_predicate "gr_register_operand"
|
|
(match_operand 0 "register_operand")
|
|
@{
|
|
unsigned int regno;
|
|
if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
|
|
op = SUBREG_REG (op);
|
|
|
|
regno = REGNO (op);
|
|
return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || GENERAL_REGNO_P (regno));
|
|
@})
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Predicates written with @code{define_predicate} automatically include
|
|
a test that @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, or @var{op} has the same
|
|
mode as @var{mode}, or @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or
|
|
@code{CONST_DOUBLE}. They do @emph{not} check specifically for
|
|
integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE}, nor do they test that the value of either
|
|
kind of constant fits in the requested mode. This is because
|
|
target-specific predicates that take constants usually have to do more
|
|
stringent value checks anyway. If you need the exact same treatment
|
|
of @code{CONST_INT} or @code{CONST_DOUBLE} that the generic predicates
|
|
provide, use a @code{MATCH_OPERAND} subexpression to call
|
|
@code{const_int_operand}, @code{const_double_operand}, or
|
|
@code{immediate_operand}.
|
|
|
|
Predicates written with @code{define_special_predicate} do not get any
|
|
automatic mode checks, and are treated as having special mode handling
|
|
by @command{genrecog}.
|
|
|
|
The program @command{genpreds} is responsible for generating code to
|
|
test predicates. It also writes a header file containing function
|
|
declarations for all machine-specific predicates. It is not necessary
|
|
to declare these predicates in @file{@var{cpu}-protos.h}.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@c Most of this node appears by itself (in a different place) even
|
|
@c when the INTERNALS flag is clear. Passages that require the internals
|
|
@c manual's context are conditionalized to appear only in the internals manual.
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Constraints
|
|
@section Operand Constraints
|
|
@cindex operand constraints
|
|
@cindex constraints
|
|
|
|
Each @code{match_operand} in an instruction pattern can specify
|
|
constraints for the operands allowed. The constraints allow you to
|
|
fine-tune matching within the set of operands allowed by the
|
|
predicate.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifclear INTERNALS
|
|
@node Constraints
|
|
@section Constraints for @code{asm} Operands
|
|
@cindex operand constraints, @code{asm}
|
|
@cindex constraints, @code{asm}
|
|
@cindex @code{asm} constraints
|
|
|
|
Here are specific details on what constraint letters you can use with
|
|
@code{asm} operands.
|
|
@end ifclear
|
|
Constraints can say whether
|
|
an operand may be in a register, and which kinds of register; whether the
|
|
operand can be a memory reference, and which kinds of address; whether the
|
|
operand may be an immediate constant, and which possible values it may
|
|
have. Constraints can also require two operands to match.
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
|
|
* Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
|
|
* Class Preferences:: Constraints guide which hard register to put things in.
|
|
* Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
|
|
* Machine Constraints:: Existing constraints for some particular machines.
|
|
* Define Constraints:: How to define machine-specific constraints.
|
|
* C Constraint Interface:: How to test constraints from C code.
|
|
@end menu
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@ifclear INTERNALS
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
|
|
* Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
|
|
* Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
|
|
* Machine Constraints:: Special constraints for some particular machines.
|
|
@end menu
|
|
@end ifclear
|
|
|
|
@node Simple Constraints
|
|
@subsection Simple Constraints
|
|
@cindex simple constraints
|
|
|
|
The simplest kind of constraint is a string full of letters, each of
|
|
which describes one kind of operand that is permitted. Here are
|
|
the letters that are allowed:
|
|
|
|
@table @asis
|
|
@item whitespace
|
|
Whitespace characters are ignored and can be inserted at any position
|
|
except the first. This enables each alternative for different operands to
|
|
be visually aligned in the machine description even if they have different
|
|
number of constraints and modifiers.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{m} in constraint
|
|
@cindex memory references in constraints
|
|
@item @samp{m}
|
|
A memory operand is allowed, with any kind of address that the machine
|
|
supports in general.
|
|
|
|
@cindex offsettable address
|
|
@cindex @samp{o} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{o}
|
|
A memory operand is allowed, but only if the address is
|
|
@dfn{offsettable}. This means that adding a small integer (actually,
|
|
the width in bytes of the operand, as determined by its machine mode)
|
|
may be added to the address and the result is also a valid memory
|
|
address.
|
|
|
|
@cindex autoincrement/decrement addressing
|
|
For example, an address which is constant is offsettable; so is an
|
|
address that is the sum of a register and a constant (as long as a
|
|
slightly larger constant is also within the range of address-offsets
|
|
supported by the machine); but an autoincrement or autodecrement
|
|
address is not offsettable. More complicated indirect/indexed
|
|
addresses may or may not be offsettable depending on the other
|
|
addressing modes that the machine supports.
|
|
|
|
Note that in an output operand which can be matched by another
|
|
operand, the constraint letter @samp{o} is valid only when accompanied
|
|
by both @samp{<} (if the target machine has predecrement addressing)
|
|
and @samp{>} (if the target machine has preincrement addressing).
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{V} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{V}
|
|
A memory operand that is not offsettable. In other words, anything that
|
|
would fit the @samp{m} constraint but not the @samp{o} constraint.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{<} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{<}
|
|
A memory operand with autodecrement addressing (either predecrement or
|
|
postdecrement) is allowed.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{>} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{>}
|
|
A memory operand with autoincrement addressing (either preincrement or
|
|
postincrement) is allowed.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{r} in constraint
|
|
@cindex registers in constraints
|
|
@item @samp{r}
|
|
A register operand is allowed provided that it is in a general
|
|
register.
|
|
|
|
@cindex constants in constraints
|
|
@cindex @samp{i} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{i}
|
|
An immediate integer operand (one with constant value) is allowed.
|
|
This includes symbolic constants whose values will be known only at
|
|
assembly time or later.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{n} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{n}
|
|
An immediate integer operand with a known numeric value is allowed.
|
|
Many systems cannot support assembly-time constants for operands less
|
|
than a word wide. Constraints for these operands should use @samp{n}
|
|
rather than @samp{i}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{I} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}
|
|
Other letters in the range @samp{I} through @samp{P} may be defined in
|
|
a machine-dependent fashion to permit immediate integer operands with
|
|
explicit integer values in specified ranges. For example, on the
|
|
68000, @samp{I} is defined to stand for the range of values 1 to 8.
|
|
This is the range permitted as a shift count in the shift
|
|
instructions.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{E} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{E}
|
|
An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double}) is
|
|
allowed, but only if the target floating point format is the same as
|
|
that of the host machine (on which the compiler is running).
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{F} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{F}
|
|
An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double} or
|
|
@code{const_vector}) is allowed.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{G} in constraint
|
|
@cindex @samp{H} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{G}, @samp{H}
|
|
@samp{G} and @samp{H} may be defined in a machine-dependent fashion to
|
|
permit immediate floating operands in particular ranges of values.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{s} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{s}
|
|
An immediate integer operand whose value is not an explicit integer is
|
|
allowed.
|
|
|
|
This might appear strange; if an insn allows a constant operand with a
|
|
value not known at compile time, it certainly must allow any known
|
|
value. So why use @samp{s} instead of @samp{i}? Sometimes it allows
|
|
better code to be generated.
|
|
|
|
For example, on the 68000 in a fullword instruction it is possible to
|
|
use an immediate operand; but if the immediate value is between @minus{}128
|
|
and 127, better code results from loading the value into a register and
|
|
using the register. This is because the load into the register can be
|
|
done with a @samp{moveq} instruction. We arrange for this to happen
|
|
by defining the letter @samp{K} to mean ``any integer outside the
|
|
range @minus{}128 to 127'', and then specifying @samp{Ks} in the operand
|
|
constraints.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{g} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{g}
|
|
Any register, memory or immediate integer operand is allowed, except for
|
|
registers that are not general registers.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{X} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{X}
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
Any operand whatsoever is allowed, even if it does not satisfy
|
|
@code{general_operand}. This is normally used in the constraint of
|
|
a @code{match_scratch} when certain alternatives will not actually
|
|
require a scratch register.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifclear INTERNALS
|
|
Any operand whatsoever is allowed.
|
|
@end ifclear
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{0} in constraint
|
|
@cindex digits in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{0}, @samp{1}, @samp{2}, @dots{} @samp{9}
|
|
An operand that matches the specified operand number is allowed. If a
|
|
digit is used together with letters within the same alternative, the
|
|
digit should come last.
|
|
|
|
This number is allowed to be more than a single digit. If multiple
|
|
digits are encountered consecutively, they are interpreted as a single
|
|
decimal integer. There is scant chance for ambiguity, since to-date
|
|
it has never been desirable that @samp{10} be interpreted as matching
|
|
either operand 1 @emph{or} operand 0. Should this be desired, one
|
|
can use multiple alternatives instead.
|
|
|
|
@cindex matching constraint
|
|
@cindex constraint, matching
|
|
This is called a @dfn{matching constraint} and what it really means is
|
|
that the assembler has only a single operand that fills two roles
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
considered separate in the RTL insn. For example, an add insn has two
|
|
input operands and one output operand in the RTL, but on most CISC
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifclear INTERNALS
|
|
which @code{asm} distinguishes. For example, an add instruction uses
|
|
two input operands and an output operand, but on most CISC
|
|
@end ifclear
|
|
machines an add instruction really has only two operands, one of them an
|
|
input-output operand:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
addl #35,r12
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Matching constraints are used in these circumstances.
|
|
More precisely, the two operands that match must include one input-only
|
|
operand and one output-only operand. Moreover, the digit must be a
|
|
smaller number than the number of the operand that uses it in the
|
|
constraint.
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
For operands to match in a particular case usually means that they
|
|
are identical-looking RTL expressions. But in a few special cases
|
|
specific kinds of dissimilarity are allowed. For example, @code{*x}
|
|
as an input operand will match @code{*x++} as an output operand.
|
|
For proper results in such cases, the output template should always
|
|
use the output-operand's number when printing the operand.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@cindex load address instruction
|
|
@cindex push address instruction
|
|
@cindex address constraints
|
|
@cindex @samp{p} in constraint
|
|
@item @samp{p}
|
|
An operand that is a valid memory address is allowed. This is
|
|
for ``load address'' and ``push address'' instructions.
|
|
|
|
@findex address_operand
|
|
@samp{p} in the constraint must be accompanied by @code{address_operand}
|
|
as the predicate in the @code{match_operand}. This predicate interprets
|
|
the mode specified in the @code{match_operand} as the mode of the memory
|
|
reference for which the address would be valid.
|
|
|
|
@cindex other register constraints
|
|
@cindex extensible constraints
|
|
@item @var{other-letters}
|
|
Other letters can be defined in machine-dependent fashion to stand for
|
|
particular classes of registers or other arbitrary operand types.
|
|
@samp{d}, @samp{a} and @samp{f} are defined on the 68000/68020 to stand
|
|
for data, address and floating point registers.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
In order to have valid assembler code, each operand must satisfy
|
|
its constraint. But a failure to do so does not prevent the pattern
|
|
from applying to an insn. Instead, it directs the compiler to modify
|
|
the code so that the constraint will be satisfied. Usually this is
|
|
done by copying an operand into a register.
|
|
|
|
Contrast, therefore, the two instruction patterns that follow:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
|
|
(plus:SI (match_dup 0)
|
|
(match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r")))]
|
|
""
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
which has two operands, one of which must appear in two places, and
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
|
|
(plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "r")))]
|
|
""
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
which has three operands, two of which are required by a constraint to be
|
|
identical. If we are considering an insn of the form
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(insn @var{n} @var{prev} @var{next}
|
|
(set (reg:SI 3)
|
|
(plus:SI (reg:SI 6) (reg:SI 109)))
|
|
@dots{})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
the first pattern would not apply at all, because this insn does not
|
|
contain two identical subexpressions in the right place. The pattern would
|
|
say, ``That does not look like an add instruction; try other patterns''.
|
|
The second pattern would say, ``Yes, that's an add instruction, but there
|
|
is something wrong with it''. It would direct the reload pass of the
|
|
compiler to generate additional insns to make the constraint true. The
|
|
results might look like this:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(insn @var{n2} @var{prev} @var{n}
|
|
(set (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 6))
|
|
@dots{})
|
|
|
|
(insn @var{n} @var{n2} @var{next}
|
|
(set (reg:SI 3)
|
|
(plus:SI (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 109)))
|
|
@dots{})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
It is up to you to make sure that each operand, in each pattern, has
|
|
constraints that can handle any RTL expression that could be present for
|
|
that operand. (When multiple alternatives are in use, each pattern must,
|
|
for each possible combination of operand expressions, have at least one
|
|
alternative which can handle that combination of operands.) The
|
|
constraints don't need to @emph{allow} any possible operand---when this is
|
|
the case, they do not constrain---but they must at least point the way to
|
|
reloading any possible operand so that it will fit.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
If the constraint accepts whatever operands the predicate permits,
|
|
there is no problem: reloading is never necessary for this operand.
|
|
|
|
For example, an operand whose constraints permit everything except
|
|
registers is safe provided its predicate rejects registers.
|
|
|
|
An operand whose predicate accepts only constant values is safe
|
|
provided its constraints include the letter @samp{i}. If any possible
|
|
constant value is accepted, then nothing less than @samp{i} will do;
|
|
if the predicate is more selective, then the constraints may also be
|
|
more selective.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
Any operand expression can be reloaded by copying it into a register.
|
|
So if an operand's constraints allow some kind of register, it is
|
|
certain to be safe. It need not permit all classes of registers; the
|
|
compiler knows how to copy a register into another register of the
|
|
proper class in order to make an instruction valid.
|
|
|
|
@cindex nonoffsettable memory reference
|
|
@cindex memory reference, nonoffsettable
|
|
@item
|
|
A nonoffsettable memory reference can be reloaded by copying the
|
|
address into a register. So if the constraint uses the letter
|
|
@samp{o}, all memory references are taken care of.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
A constant operand can be reloaded by allocating space in memory to
|
|
hold it as preinitialized data. Then the memory reference can be used
|
|
in place of the constant. So if the constraint uses the letters
|
|
@samp{o} or @samp{m}, constant operands are not a problem.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
If the constraint permits a constant and a pseudo register used in an insn
|
|
was not allocated to a hard register and is equivalent to a constant,
|
|
the register will be replaced with the constant. If the predicate does
|
|
not permit a constant and the insn is re-recognized for some reason, the
|
|
compiler will crash. Thus the predicate must always recognize any
|
|
objects allowed by the constraint.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
If the operand's predicate can recognize registers, but the constraint does
|
|
not permit them, it can make the compiler crash. When this operand happens
|
|
to be a register, the reload pass will be stymied, because it does not know
|
|
how to copy a register temporarily into memory.
|
|
|
|
If the predicate accepts a unary operator, the constraint applies to the
|
|
operand. For example, the MIPS processor at ISA level 3 supports an
|
|
instruction which adds two registers in @code{SImode} to produce a
|
|
@code{DImode} result, but only if the registers are correctly sign
|
|
extended. This predicate for the input operands accepts a
|
|
@code{sign_extend} of an @code{SImode} register. Write the constraint
|
|
to indicate the type of register that is required for the operand of the
|
|
@code{sign_extend}.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@node Multi-Alternative
|
|
@subsection Multiple Alternative Constraints
|
|
@cindex multiple alternative constraints
|
|
|
|
Sometimes a single instruction has multiple alternative sets of possible
|
|
operands. For example, on the 68000, a logical-or instruction can combine
|
|
register or an immediate value into memory, or it can combine any kind of
|
|
operand into a register; but it cannot combine one memory location into
|
|
another.
|
|
|
|
These constraints are represented as multiple alternatives. An alternative
|
|
can be described by a series of letters for each operand. The overall
|
|
constraint for an operand is made from the letters for this operand
|
|
from the first alternative, a comma, the letters for this operand from
|
|
the second alternative, a comma, and so on until the last alternative.
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
Here is how it is done for fullword logical-or on the 68000:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "iorsi3"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=m,d")
|
|
(ior:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dKs,dmKs")))]
|
|
@dots{})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The first alternative has @samp{m} (memory) for operand 0, @samp{0} for
|
|
operand 1 (meaning it must match operand 0), and @samp{dKs} for operand
|
|
2. The second alternative has @samp{d} (data register) for operand 0,
|
|
@samp{0} for operand 1, and @samp{dmKs} for operand 2. The @samp{=} and
|
|
@samp{%} in the constraints apply to all the alternatives; their
|
|
meaning is explained in the next section (@pxref{Class Preferences}).
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@c FIXME Is this ? and ! stuff of use in asm()? If not, hide unless INTERNAL
|
|
If all the operands fit any one alternative, the instruction is valid.
|
|
Otherwise, for each alternative, the compiler counts how many instructions
|
|
must be added to copy the operands so that that alternative applies.
|
|
The alternative requiring the least copying is chosen. If two alternatives
|
|
need the same amount of copying, the one that comes first is chosen.
|
|
These choices can be altered with the @samp{?} and @samp{!} characters:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@cindex @samp{?} in constraint
|
|
@cindex question mark
|
|
@item ?
|
|
Disparage slightly the alternative that the @samp{?} appears in,
|
|
as a choice when no alternative applies exactly. The compiler regards
|
|
this alternative as one unit more costly for each @samp{?} that appears
|
|
in it.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{!} in constraint
|
|
@cindex exclamation point
|
|
@item !
|
|
Disparage severely the alternative that the @samp{!} appears in.
|
|
This alternative can still be used if it fits without reloading,
|
|
but if reloading is needed, some other alternative will be used.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
|
|
the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which
|
|
alternative was matched. When this is so, the C code for writing the
|
|
assembler code can use the variable @code{which_alternative}, which is
|
|
the ordinal number of the alternative that was actually satisfied (0 for
|
|
the first, 1 for the second alternative, etc.). @xref{Output Statement}.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Class Preferences
|
|
@subsection Register Class Preferences
|
|
@cindex class preference constraints
|
|
@cindex register class preference constraints
|
|
|
|
@cindex voting between constraint alternatives
|
|
The operand constraints have another function: they enable the compiler
|
|
to decide which kind of hardware register a pseudo register is best
|
|
allocated to. The compiler examines the constraints that apply to the
|
|
insns that use the pseudo register, looking for the machine-dependent
|
|
letters such as @samp{d} and @samp{a} that specify classes of registers.
|
|
The pseudo register is put in whichever class gets the most ``votes''.
|
|
The constraint letters @samp{g} and @samp{r} also vote: they vote in
|
|
favor of a general register. The machine description says which registers
|
|
are considered general.
|
|
|
|
Of course, on some machines all registers are equivalent, and no register
|
|
classes are defined. Then none of this complexity is relevant.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@node Modifiers
|
|
@subsection Constraint Modifier Characters
|
|
@cindex modifiers in constraints
|
|
@cindex constraint modifier characters
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
Here are constraint modifier characters.
|
|
|
|
@table @samp
|
|
@cindex @samp{=} in constraint
|
|
@item =
|
|
Means that this operand is write-only for this instruction: the previous
|
|
value is discarded and replaced by output data.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{+} in constraint
|
|
@item +
|
|
Means that this operand is both read and written by the instruction.
|
|
|
|
When the compiler fixes up the operands to satisfy the constraints,
|
|
it needs to know which operands are inputs to the instruction and
|
|
which are outputs from it. @samp{=} identifies an output; @samp{+}
|
|
identifies an operand that is both input and output; all other operands
|
|
are assumed to be input only.
|
|
|
|
If you specify @samp{=} or @samp{+} in a constraint, you put it in the
|
|
first character of the constraint string.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{&} in constraint
|
|
@cindex earlyclobber operand
|
|
@item &
|
|
Means (in a particular alternative) that this operand is an
|
|
@dfn{earlyclobber} operand, which is modified before the instruction is
|
|
finished using the input operands. Therefore, this operand may not lie
|
|
in a register that is used as an input operand or as part of any memory
|
|
address.
|
|
|
|
@samp{&} applies only to the alternative in which it is written. In
|
|
constraints with multiple alternatives, sometimes one alternative
|
|
requires @samp{&} while others do not. See, for example, the
|
|
@samp{movdf} insn of the 68000.
|
|
|
|
An input operand can be tied to an earlyclobber operand if its only
|
|
use as an input occurs before the early result is written. Adding
|
|
alternatives of this form often allows GCC to produce better code
|
|
when only some of the inputs can be affected by the earlyclobber.
|
|
See, for example, the @samp{mulsi3} insn of the ARM@.
|
|
|
|
@samp{&} does not obviate the need to write @samp{=}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{%} in constraint
|
|
@item %
|
|
Declares the instruction to be commutative for this operand and the
|
|
following operand. This means that the compiler may interchange the
|
|
two operands if that is the cheapest way to make all operands fit the
|
|
constraints.
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
This is often used in patterns for addition instructions
|
|
that really have only two operands: the result must go in one of the
|
|
arguments. Here for example, is how the 68000 halfword-add
|
|
instruction is defined:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "addhi3"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:HI 0 "general_operand" "=m,r")
|
|
(plus:HI (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
|
|
(match_operand:HI 2 "general_operand" "di,g")))]
|
|
@dots{})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
GCC can only handle one commutative pair in an asm; if you use more,
|
|
the compiler may fail. Note that you need not use the modifier if
|
|
the two alternatives are strictly identical; this would only waste
|
|
time in the reload pass. The modifier is not operational after
|
|
register allocation, so the result of @code{define_peephole2}
|
|
and @code{define_split}s performed after reload cannot rely on
|
|
@samp{%} to make the intended insn match.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{#} in constraint
|
|
@item #
|
|
Says that all following characters, up to the next comma, are to be
|
|
ignored as a constraint. They are significant only for choosing
|
|
register preferences.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{*} in constraint
|
|
@item *
|
|
Says that the following character should be ignored when choosing
|
|
register preferences. @samp{*} has no effect on the meaning of the
|
|
constraint as a constraint, and no effect on reloading.
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
Here is an example: the 68000 has an instruction to sign-extend a
|
|
halfword in a data register, and can also sign-extend a value by
|
|
copying it into an address register. While either kind of register is
|
|
acceptable, the constraints on an address-register destination are
|
|
less strict, so it is best if register allocation makes an address
|
|
register its goal. Therefore, @samp{*} is used so that the @samp{d}
|
|
constraint letter (for data register) is ignored when computing
|
|
register preferences.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "extendhisi2"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=*d,a")
|
|
(sign_extend:SI
|
|
(match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "0,g")))]
|
|
@dots{})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Machine Constraints
|
|
@subsection Constraints for Particular Machines
|
|
@cindex machine specific constraints
|
|
@cindex constraints, machine specific
|
|
|
|
Whenever possible, you should use the general-purpose constraint letters
|
|
in @code{asm} arguments, since they will convey meaning more readily to
|
|
people reading your code. Failing that, use the constraint letters
|
|
that usually have very similar meanings across architectures. The most
|
|
commonly used constraints are @samp{m} and @samp{r} (for memory and
|
|
general-purpose registers respectively; @pxref{Simple Constraints}), and
|
|
@samp{I}, usually the letter indicating the most common
|
|
immediate-constant format.
|
|
|
|
Each architecture defines additional constraints. These constraints
|
|
are used by the compiler itself for instruction generation, as well as
|
|
for @code{asm} statements; therefore, some of the constraints are not
|
|
particularly useful for @code{asm}. Here is a summary of some of the
|
|
machine-dependent constraints available on some particular machines;
|
|
it includes both constraints that are useful for @code{asm} and
|
|
constraints that aren't. The compiler source file mentioned in the
|
|
table heading for each architecture is the definitive reference for
|
|
the meanings of that architecture's constraints.
|
|
|
|
@table @emph
|
|
@item ARM family---@file{config/arm/arm.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item f
|
|
Floating-point register
|
|
|
|
@item w
|
|
VFP floating-point register
|
|
|
|
@item F
|
|
One of the floating-point constants 0.0, 0.5, 1.0, 2.0, 3.0, 4.0, 5.0
|
|
or 10.0
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating-point constant that would satisfy the constraint @samp{F} if it
|
|
were negated
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in a data processing
|
|
instruction. That is, an integer in the range 0 to 255 rotated by a
|
|
multiple of 2
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Integer in the range @minus{}4095 to 4095
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when inverted (ones complement)
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when negated (twos complement)
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Integer in the range 0 to 32
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
A memory reference where the exact address is in a single register
|
|
(`@samp{m}' is preferable for @code{asm} statements)
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
An item in the constant pool
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
A symbol in the text segment of the current file
|
|
|
|
@item Uv
|
|
A memory reference suitable for VFP load/store insns (reg+constant offset)
|
|
|
|
@item Uy
|
|
A memory reference suitable for iWMMXt load/store instructions.
|
|
|
|
@item Uq
|
|
A memory reference suitable for the ARMv4 ldrsb instruction.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item AVR family---@file{config/avr/constraints.md}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item l
|
|
Registers from r0 to r15
|
|
|
|
@item a
|
|
Registers from r16 to r23
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Registers from r16 to r31
|
|
|
|
@item w
|
|
Registers from r24 to r31. These registers can be used in @samp{adiw} command
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
Pointer register (r26--r31)
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Base pointer register (r28--r31)
|
|
|
|
@item q
|
|
Stack pointer register (SPH:SPL)
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
Temporary register r0
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
Register pair X (r27:r26)
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
Register pair Y (r29:r28)
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
Register pair Z (r31:r30)
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Constant greater than @minus{}1, less than 64
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Constant greater than @minus{}64, less than 1
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Constant integer 2
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Constant integer 0
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Constant that fits in 8 bits
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Constant integer @minus{}1
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
Constant integer 8, 16, or 24
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
Constant integer 1
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
A floating point constant 0.0
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item CRX Architecture---@file{config/crx/crx.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Registers from r0 to r14 (registers without stack pointer)
|
|
|
|
@item l
|
|
Register r16 (64-bit accumulator lo register)
|
|
|
|
@item h
|
|
Register r17 (64-bit accumulator hi register)
|
|
|
|
@item k
|
|
Register pair r16-r17. (64-bit accumulator lo-hi pair)
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Constant that fits in 3 bits
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Constant that fits in 4 bits
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Constant that fits in 5 bits
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Constant that is one of -1, 4, -4, 7, 8, 12, 16, 20, 32, 48
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating point constant that is legal for store immediate
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item PowerPC and IBM RS6000---@file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item b
|
|
Address base register
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
Floating point register
|
|
|
|
@item v
|
|
Vector register
|
|
|
|
@item h
|
|
@samp{MQ}, @samp{CTR}, or @samp{LINK} register
|
|
|
|
@item q
|
|
@samp{MQ} register
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
@samp{CTR} register
|
|
|
|
@item l
|
|
@samp{LINK} register
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
@samp{CR} register (condition register) number 0
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
@samp{CR} register (condition register)
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
@samp{FPMEM} stack memory for FPR-GPR transfers
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Signed 16-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Unsigned 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits (use @samp{L} instead for
|
|
@code{SImode} constants)
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Unsigned 16-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Signed 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Constant larger than 31
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Exact power of 2
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
Zero
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
Constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating point constant that can be loaded into a register with one
|
|
instruction per word
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
Memory operand that is an offset from a register (@samp{m} is preferable
|
|
for @code{asm} statements)
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
AIX TOC entry
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
Constant suitable as a 64-bit mask operand
|
|
|
|
@item T
|
|
Constant suitable as a 32-bit mask operand
|
|
|
|
@item U
|
|
System V Release 4 small data area reference
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item MorphoTech family---@file{config/mt/mt.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item I
|
|
Constant for an arithmetic insn (16-bit signed integer).
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
The constant 0.
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Constant for a logical insn (16-bit zero-extended integer).
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
A constant that can be loaded with @code{lui} (i.e.@: the bottom 16
|
|
bits are zero).
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
A constant that takes two words to load (i.e.@: not matched by
|
|
@code{I}, @code{K}, or @code{L}).
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Negative 16-bit constants other than -65536.
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
A 15-bit signed integer constant.
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
A positive 16-bit constant.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Intel 386---@file{config/i386/constraints.md}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item R
|
|
Legacy register---the eight integer registers available on all
|
|
i386 processors (@code{a}, @code{b}, @code{c}, @code{d},
|
|
@code{si}, @code{di}, @code{bp}, @code{sp}).
|
|
|
|
@item q
|
|
Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}l}. In 32-bit mode, @code{a},
|
|
@code{b}, @code{c}, and @code{d}; in 64-bit mode, any integer register.
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}h}: @code{a}, @code{b},
|
|
@code{c}, and @code{d}.
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@item l
|
|
Any register that can be used as the index in a base+index memory
|
|
access: that is, any general register except the stack pointer.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@item a
|
|
The @code{a} register.
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
The @code{b} register.
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
The @code{c} register.
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
The @code{d} register.
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
The @code{si} register.
|
|
|
|
@item D
|
|
The @code{di} register.
|
|
|
|
@item A
|
|
The @code{a} and @code{d} registers, as a pair (for instructions that
|
|
return half the result in one and half in the other).
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
Any 80387 floating-point (stack) register.
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
Top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(0)}).
|
|
|
|
@item u
|
|
Second from top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(1)}).
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
Any MMX register.
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
Any SSE register.
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@item Y
|
|
Any SSE2 register.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 31, for 32-bit shifts.
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 63, for 64-bit shifts.
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Signed 8-bit integer constant.
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
@code{0xFF} or @code{0xFFFF}, for andsi as a zero-extending move.
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
0, 1, 2, or 3 (shifts for the @code{lea} instruction).
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Unsigned 8-bit integer constant (for @code{in} and @code{out}
|
|
instructions).
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@item O
|
|
Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 127, for 128-bit shifts.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Standard 80387 floating point constant.
|
|
|
|
@item C
|
|
Standard SSE floating point constant.
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
32-bit signed integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
|
|
to fit that range (for immediate operands in sign-extending x86-64
|
|
instructions).
|
|
|
|
@item Z
|
|
32-bit unsigned integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
|
|
to fit that range (for immediate operands in zero-extending x86-64
|
|
instructions).
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Intel IA-64---@file{config/ia64/ia64.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
General register @code{r0} to @code{r3} for @code{addl} instruction
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Branch register
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
Predicate register (@samp{c} as in ``conditional'')
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Application register residing in M-unit
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
Application register residing in I-unit
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
Floating-point register
|
|
|
|
@item m
|
|
Memory operand.
|
|
Remember that @samp{m} allows postincrement and postdecrement which
|
|
require printing with @samp{%Pn} on IA-64.
|
|
Use @samp{S} to disallow postincrement and postdecrement.
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating-point constant 0.0 or 1.0
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
14-bit signed integer constant
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
22-bit signed integer constant
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
8-bit signed integer constant for logical instructions
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
8-bit adjusted signed integer constant for compare pseudo-ops
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
6-bit unsigned integer constant for shift counts
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
9-bit signed integer constant for load and store postincrements
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
The constant zero
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
0 or @minus{}1 for @code{dep} instruction
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
Non-volatile memory for floating-point loads and stores
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
Integer constant in the range 1 to 4 for @code{shladd} instruction
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
Memory operand except postincrement and postdecrement
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item FRV---@file{config/frv/frv.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
Register in the class @code{ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Register in the class @code{EVEN_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
Register in the class @code{CC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3} and
|
|
@code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Register in the class @code{GPR_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
Register in the class @code{EVEN_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
|
|
Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
|
|
mode larger than 4 bytes.
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
Register in the class @code{FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
|
|
|
|
@item h
|
|
Register in the class @code{FEVEN_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
|
|
Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
|
|
mode larger than 4 bytes.
|
|
|
|
@item l
|
|
Register in the class @code{LR_REG} (the @code{lr} register).
|
|
|
|
@item q
|
|
Register in the class @code{QUAD_REGS} (@code{gr2} to @code{gr63}).
|
|
Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
|
|
the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
Register in the class @code{ICC_REGS} (@code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
|
|
|
|
@item u
|
|
Register in the class @code{FCC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3}).
|
|
|
|
@item v
|
|
Register in the class @code{ICR_REGS} (@code{cc4} to @code{cc7}).
|
|
|
|
@item w
|
|
Register in the class @code{FCR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc3}).
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
Register in the class @code{QUAD_FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
|
|
Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
|
|
the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
Register in the class @code{SPR_REGS} (@code{lcr} and @code{lr}).
|
|
|
|
@item A
|
|
Register in the class @code{QUAD_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
|
|
|
|
@item B
|
|
Register in the class @code{ACCG_REGS} (@code{accg0} to @code{accg7}).
|
|
|
|
@item C
|
|
Register in the class @code{CR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc7}).
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating point constant zero
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
6-bit signed integer constant
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
10-bit signed integer constant
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
16-bit signed integer constant
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
16-bit unsigned integer constant
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
12-bit signed integer constant that is negative---i.e.@: in the
|
|
range of @minus{}2048 to @minus{}1
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
Constant zero
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
12-bit signed integer constant that is greater than zero---i.e.@: in the
|
|
range of 1 to 2047.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Blackfin family---@file{config/bfin/bfin.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
P register
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
D register
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
A call clobbered P register.
|
|
|
|
@item D
|
|
Even-numbered D register
|
|
|
|
@item W
|
|
Odd-numbered D register
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
Accumulator register.
|
|
|
|
@item A
|
|
Even-numbered accumulator register.
|
|
|
|
@item B
|
|
Odd-numbered accumulator register.
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
I register
|
|
|
|
@item v
|
|
B register
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
M register
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
Registers used for circular buffering, i.e. I, B, or L registers.
|
|
|
|
@item C
|
|
The CC register.
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
LT0 or LT1.
|
|
|
|
@item k
|
|
LC0 or LC1.
|
|
|
|
@item u
|
|
LB0 or LB1.
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
Any D, P, B, M, I or L register.
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
Additional registers typically used only in prologues and epilogues: RETS,
|
|
RETN, RETI, RETX, RETE, ASTAT, SEQSTAT and USP.
|
|
|
|
@item w
|
|
Any register except accumulators or CC.
|
|
|
|
@item Ksh
|
|
Signed 16 bit integer (in the range -32768 to 32767)
|
|
|
|
@item Kuh
|
|
Unsigned 16 bit integer (in the range 0 to 65535)
|
|
|
|
@item Ks7
|
|
Signed 7 bit integer (in the range -64 to 63)
|
|
|
|
@item Ku7
|
|
Unsigned 7 bit integer (in the range 0 to 127)
|
|
|
|
@item Ku5
|
|
Unsigned 5 bit integer (in the range 0 to 31)
|
|
|
|
@item Ks4
|
|
Signed 4 bit integer (in the range -8 to 7)
|
|
|
|
@item Ks3
|
|
Signed 3 bit integer (in the range -3 to 4)
|
|
|
|
@item Ku3
|
|
Unsigned 3 bit integer (in the range 0 to 7)
|
|
|
|
@item P@var{n}
|
|
Constant @var{n}, where @var{n} is a single-digit constant in the range 0 to 4.
|
|
|
|
@item M1
|
|
Constant 255.
|
|
|
|
@item M2
|
|
Constant 65535.
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
An integer constant with exactly a single bit set.
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
An integer constant with all bits set except exactly one.
|
|
|
|
@item H
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
Any SYMBOL_REF.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item M32C---@file{config/m32c/m32c.c}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item Rsp
|
|
@itemx Rfb
|
|
@itemx Rsb
|
|
@samp{$sp}, @samp{$fb}, @samp{$sb}.
|
|
|
|
@item Rcr
|
|
Any control register, when they're 16 bits wide (nothing if control
|
|
registers are 24 bits wide)
|
|
|
|
@item Rcl
|
|
Any control register, when they're 24 bits wide.
|
|
|
|
@item R0w
|
|
@itemx R1w
|
|
@itemx R2w
|
|
@itemx R3w
|
|
$r0, $r1, $r2, $r3.
|
|
|
|
@item R02
|
|
$r0 or $r2, or $r2r0 for 32 bit values.
|
|
|
|
@item R13
|
|
$r1 or $r3, or $r3r1 for 32 bit values.
|
|
|
|
@item Rdi
|
|
A register that can hold a 64 bit value.
|
|
|
|
@item Rhl
|
|
$r0 or $r1 (registers with addressable high/low bytes)
|
|
|
|
@item R23
|
|
$r2 or $r3
|
|
|
|
@item Raa
|
|
Address registers
|
|
|
|
@item Raw
|
|
Address registers when they're 16 bits wide.
|
|
|
|
@item Ral
|
|
Address registers when they're 24 bits wide.
|
|
|
|
@item Rqi
|
|
Registers that can hold QI values.
|
|
|
|
@item Rad
|
|
Registers that can be used with displacements ($a0, $a1, $sb).
|
|
|
|
@item Rsi
|
|
Registers that can hold 32 bit values.
|
|
|
|
@item Rhi
|
|
Registers that can hold 16 bit values.
|
|
|
|
@item Rhc
|
|
Registers chat can hold 16 bit values, including all control
|
|
registers.
|
|
|
|
@item Rra
|
|
$r0 through R1, plus $a0 and $a1.
|
|
|
|
@item Rfl
|
|
The flags register.
|
|
|
|
@item Rmm
|
|
The memory-based pseudo-registers $mem0 through $mem15.
|
|
|
|
@item Rpi
|
|
Registers that can hold pointers (16 bit registers for r8c, m16c; 24
|
|
bit registers for m32cm, m32c).
|
|
|
|
@item Rpa
|
|
Matches multiple registers in a PARALLEL to form a larger register.
|
|
Used to match function return values.
|
|
|
|
@item Is3
|
|
-8 @dots{} 7
|
|
|
|
@item IS1
|
|
-128 @dots{} 127
|
|
|
|
@item IS2
|
|
-32768 @dots{} 32767
|
|
|
|
@item IU2
|
|
0 @dots{} 65535
|
|
|
|
@item In4
|
|
-8 @dots{} -1 or 1 @dots{} 8
|
|
|
|
@item In5
|
|
-16 @dots{} -1 or 1 @dots{} 16
|
|
|
|
@item In6
|
|
-32 @dots{} -1 or 1 @dots{} 32
|
|
|
|
@item IM2
|
|
-65536 @dots{} -1
|
|
|
|
@item Ilb
|
|
An 8 bit value with exactly one bit set.
|
|
|
|
@item Ilw
|
|
A 16 bit value with exactly one bit set.
|
|
|
|
@item Sd
|
|
The common src/dest memory addressing modes.
|
|
|
|
@item Sa
|
|
Memory addressed using $a0 or $a1.
|
|
|
|
@item Si
|
|
Memory addressed with immediate addresses.
|
|
|
|
@item Ss
|
|
Memory addressed using the stack pointer ($sp).
|
|
|
|
@item Sf
|
|
Memory addressed using the frame base register ($fb).
|
|
|
|
@item Ss
|
|
Memory addressed using the small base register ($sb).
|
|
|
|
@item S1
|
|
$r1h
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item MIPS---@file{config/mips/constraints.md}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item d
|
|
An address register. This is equivalent to @code{r} unless
|
|
generating MIPS16 code.
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
A floating-point register (if available).
|
|
|
|
@item h
|
|
The @code{hi} register.
|
|
|
|
@item l
|
|
The @code{lo} register.
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
The @code{hi} and @code{lo} registers.
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
A register suitable for use in an indirect jump. This will always be
|
|
@code{$25} for @option{-mabicalls}.
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
Equivalent to @code{r}; retained for backwards compatibility.
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
A floating-point condition code register.
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
A signed 16-bit constant (for arithmetic instructions).
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Integer zero.
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
An unsigned 16-bit constant (for logic instructions).
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
A signed 32-bit constant in which the lower 16 bits are zero.
|
|
Such constants can be loaded using @code{lui}.
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
A constant that cannot be loaded using @code{lui}, @code{addiu}
|
|
or @code{ori}.
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
A constant in the range -65535 to -1 (inclusive).
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
A signed 15-bit constant.
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
A constant in the range 1 to 65535 (inclusive).
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating-point zero.
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
An address that can be used in a non-macro load or store.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Motorola 680x0---@file{config/m68k/m68k.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
Address register
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Data register
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
68881 floating-point register, if available
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Integer in the range 1 to 8
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
16-bit signed number
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x80
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Integer in the range @minus{}8 to @minus{}1
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x100
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating point constant that is not a 68881 constant
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Motorola 68HC11 & 68HC12 families---@file{config/m68hc11/m68hc11.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
Register `a'
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Register `b'
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Register `d'
|
|
|
|
@item q
|
|
An 8-bit register
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
Temporary soft register _.tmp
|
|
|
|
@item u
|
|
A soft register _.d1 to _.d31
|
|
|
|
@item w
|
|
Stack pointer register
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
Register `x'
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
Register `y'
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
Pseudo register `z' (replaced by `x' or `y' at the end)
|
|
|
|
@item A
|
|
An address register: x, y or z
|
|
|
|
@item B
|
|
An address register: x or y
|
|
|
|
@item D
|
|
Register pair (x:d) to form a 32-bit value
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Constants in the range @minus{}65536 to 65535
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Constants whose 16-bit low part is zero
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Constant integer 1 or @minus{}1
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
Constant integer 16
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
Constants in the range @minus{}8 to 2
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@need 1000
|
|
@item SPARC---@file{config/sparc/sparc.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item f
|
|
Floating-point register on the SPARC-V8 architecture and
|
|
lower floating-point register on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
Floating-point register. It is equivalent to @samp{f} on the
|
|
SPARC-V8 architecture and contains both lower and upper
|
|
floating-point registers on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
Floating-point condition code register.
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Lower floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9
|
|
architecture when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9 architecture
|
|
when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
|
|
|
|
@item h
|
|
64-bit global or out register for the SPARC-V8+ architecture.
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Signed 13-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Zero
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
32-bit constant with the low 12 bits clear (a constant that can be
|
|
loaded with the @code{sethi} instruction)
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
A constant in the range supported by @code{movcc} instructions
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
A constant in the range supported by @code{movrcc} instructions
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Same as @samp{K}, except that it verifies that bits that are not in the
|
|
lower 32-bit range are all zero. Must be used instead of @samp{K} for
|
|
modes wider than @code{SImode}
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
The constant 4096
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating-point zero
|
|
|
|
@item H
|
|
Signed 13-bit constant, sign-extended to 32 or 64 bits
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
|
|
be moved into an integer register using a single sethi
|
|
instruction
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
|
|
be moved into an integer register using a single mov
|
|
instruction
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
|
|
be moved into an integer register using a high/lo_sum
|
|
instruction sequence
|
|
|
|
@item T
|
|
Memory address aligned to an 8-byte boundary
|
|
|
|
@item U
|
|
Even register
|
|
|
|
@item W
|
|
Memory address for @samp{e} constraint registers
|
|
|
|
@item Y
|
|
Vector zero
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item TMS320C3x/C4x---@file{config/c4x/c4x.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
Auxiliary (address) register (ar0-ar7)
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Stack pointer register (sp)
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
Standard (32-bit) precision integer register
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
Extended (40-bit) precision register (r0-r11)
|
|
|
|
@item k
|
|
Block count register (bk)
|
|
|
|
@item q
|
|
Extended (40-bit) precision low register (r0-r7)
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
Extended (40-bit) precision register (r0-r1)
|
|
|
|
@item u
|
|
Extended (40-bit) precision register (r2-r3)
|
|
|
|
@item v
|
|
Repeat count register (rc)
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
Index register (ir0-ir1)
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
Status (condition code) register (st)
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
Data page register (dp)
|
|
|
|
@item G
|
|
Floating-point zero
|
|
|
|
@item H
|
|
Immediate 16-bit floating-point constant
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Signed 16-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Signed 8-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Signed 5-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Unsigned 16-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Unsigned 8-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Ones complement of unsigned 16-bit constant
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
High 16-bit constant (32-bit constant with 16 LSBs zero)
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
Indirect memory reference with signed 8-bit or index register displacement
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
Indirect memory reference with unsigned 5-bit displacement
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
Indirect memory reference with 1 bit or index register displacement
|
|
|
|
@item T
|
|
Direct memory reference
|
|
|
|
@item U
|
|
Symbolic address
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item S/390 and zSeries---@file{config/s390/s390.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
Address register (general purpose register except r0)
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
Condition code register
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Data register (arbitrary general purpose register)
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
Floating-point register
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Unsigned 8-bit constant (0--255)
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Unsigned 12-bit constant (0--4095)
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Signed 16-bit constant (@minus{}32768--32767)
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Value appropriate as displacement.
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item (0..4095)
|
|
for short displacement
|
|
@item (-524288..524287)
|
|
for long displacement
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Constant integer with a value of 0x7fffffff.
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Multiple letter constraint followed by 4 parameter letters.
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item 0..9:
|
|
number of the part counting from most to least significant
|
|
@item H,Q:
|
|
mode of the part
|
|
@item D,S,H:
|
|
mode of the containing operand
|
|
@item 0,F:
|
|
value of the other parts (F---all bits set)
|
|
@end table
|
|
The constraint matches if the specified part of a constant
|
|
has a value different from it's other parts.
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
Memory reference without index register and with short displacement.
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
Memory reference with index register and short displacement.
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
Memory reference without index register but with long displacement.
|
|
|
|
@item T
|
|
Memory reference with index register and long displacement.
|
|
|
|
@item U
|
|
Pointer with short displacement.
|
|
|
|
@item W
|
|
Pointer with long displacement.
|
|
|
|
@item Y
|
|
Shift count operand.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Score family---@file{config/score/score.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item d
|
|
Registers from r0 to r32.
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
Registers from r0 to r16.
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
r8---r11 or r22---r27 registers.
|
|
|
|
@item h
|
|
hi register.
|
|
|
|
@item l
|
|
lo register.
|
|
|
|
@item x
|
|
hi + lo register.
|
|
|
|
@item q
|
|
cnt register.
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
lcb register.
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
scb register.
|
|
|
|
@item a
|
|
cnt + lcb + scb register.
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
cr0---cr15 register.
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
cp1 registers.
|
|
|
|
@item f
|
|
cp2 registers.
|
|
|
|
@item i
|
|
cp3 registers.
|
|
|
|
@item j
|
|
cp1 + cp2 + cp3 registers.
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
High 16-bit constant (32-bit constant with 16 LSBs zero).
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Unsigned 5 bit integer (in the range 0 to 31).
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Unsigned 16 bit integer (in the range 0 to 65535).
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Signed 16 bit integer (in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767).
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
Unsigned 14 bit integer (in the range 0 to 16383).
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
Signed 14 bit integer (in the range @minus{}8192 to 8191).
|
|
|
|
@item Z
|
|
Any SYMBOL_REF.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Xstormy16---@file{config/stormy16/stormy16.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
Register r0.
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
Register r1.
|
|
|
|
@item c
|
|
Register r2.
|
|
|
|
@item d
|
|
Register r8.
|
|
|
|
@item e
|
|
Registers r0 through r7.
|
|
|
|
@item t
|
|
Registers r0 and r1.
|
|
|
|
@item y
|
|
The carry register.
|
|
|
|
@item z
|
|
Registers r8 and r9.
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
A constant between 0 and 3 inclusive.
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
A constant that has exactly one bit set.
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
A constant that has exactly one bit clear.
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
A constant between 0 and 255 inclusive.
|
|
|
|
@item M
|
|
A constant between @minus{}255 and 0 inclusive.
|
|
|
|
@item N
|
|
A constant between @minus{}3 and 0 inclusive.
|
|
|
|
@item O
|
|
A constant between 1 and 4 inclusive.
|
|
|
|
@item P
|
|
A constant between @minus{}4 and @minus{}1 inclusive.
|
|
|
|
@item Q
|
|
A memory reference that is a stack push.
|
|
|
|
@item R
|
|
A memory reference that is a stack pop.
|
|
|
|
@item S
|
|
A memory reference that refers to a constant address of known value.
|
|
|
|
@item T
|
|
The register indicated by Rx (not implemented yet).
|
|
|
|
@item U
|
|
A constant that is not between 2 and 15 inclusive.
|
|
|
|
@item Z
|
|
The constant 0.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item Xtensa---@file{config/xtensa/xtensa.h}
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item a
|
|
General-purpose 32-bit register
|
|
|
|
@item b
|
|
One-bit boolean register
|
|
|
|
@item A
|
|
MAC16 40-bit accumulator register
|
|
|
|
@item I
|
|
Signed 12-bit integer constant, for use in MOVI instructions
|
|
|
|
@item J
|
|
Signed 8-bit integer constant, for use in ADDI instructions
|
|
|
|
@item K
|
|
Integer constant valid for BccI instructions
|
|
|
|
@item L
|
|
Unsigned constant valid for BccUI instructions
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Define Constraints
|
|
@subsection Defining Machine-Specific Constraints
|
|
@cindex defining constraints
|
|
@cindex constraints, defining
|
|
|
|
Machine-specific constraints fall into two categories: register and
|
|
non-register constraints. Within the latter category, constraints
|
|
which allow subsets of all possible memory or address operands should
|
|
be specially marked, to give @code{reload} more information.
|
|
|
|
Machine-specific constraints can be given names of arbitrary length,
|
|
but they must be entirely composed of letters, digits, underscores
|
|
(@samp{_}), and angle brackets (@samp{< >}). Like C identifiers, they
|
|
must begin with a letter or underscore.
|
|
|
|
In order to avoid ambiguity in operand constraint strings, no
|
|
constraint can have a name that begins with any other constraint's
|
|
name. For example, if @code{x} is defined as a constraint name,
|
|
@code{xy} may not be, and vice versa. As a consequence of this rule,
|
|
no constraint may begin with one of the generic constraint letters:
|
|
@samp{E F V X g i m n o p r s}.
|
|
|
|
Register constraints correspond directly to register classes.
|
|
@xref{Register Classes}. There is thus not much flexibility in their
|
|
definitions.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {MD Expression} define_register_constraint name regclass docstring
|
|
All three arguments are string constants.
|
|
@var{name} is the name of the constraint, as it will appear in
|
|
@code{match_operand} expressions. @var{regclass} can be either the
|
|
name of the corresponding register class (@pxref{Register Classes}),
|
|
or a C expression which evaluates to the appropriate register class.
|
|
If it is an expression, it must have no side effects, and it cannot
|
|
look at the operand. The usual use of expressions is to map some
|
|
register constraints to @code{NO_REGS} when the register class
|
|
is not available on a given subarchitecture.
|
|
|
|
@var{docstring} is a sentence documenting the meaning of the
|
|
constraint. Docstrings are explained further below.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
Non-register constraints are more like predicates: the constraint
|
|
definition gives a Boolean expression which indicates whether the
|
|
constraint matches.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {MD Expression} define_constraint name docstring exp
|
|
The @var{name} and @var{docstring} arguments are the same as for
|
|
@code{define_register_constraint}, but note that the docstring comes
|
|
immediately after the name for these expressions. @var{exp} is an RTL
|
|
expression, obeying the same rules as the RTL expressions in predicate
|
|
definitions. @xref{Defining Predicates}, for details. If it
|
|
evaluates true, the constraint matches; if it evaluates false, it
|
|
doesn't. Constraint expressions should indicate which RTL codes they
|
|
might match, just like predicate expressions.
|
|
|
|
@code{match_test} C expressions have access to the
|
|
following variables:
|
|
|
|
@table @var
|
|
@item op
|
|
The RTL object defining the operand.
|
|
@item mode
|
|
The machine mode of @var{op}.
|
|
@item ival
|
|
@samp{INTVAL (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a @code{const_int}.
|
|
@item hval
|
|
@samp{CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
|
|
@code{const_double}.
|
|
@item lval
|
|
@samp{CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
|
|
@code{const_double}.
|
|
@item rval
|
|
@samp{CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a floating-point
|
|
@code{const_double}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
The @var{*val} variables should only be used once another piece of the
|
|
expression has verified that @var{op} is the appropriate kind of RTL
|
|
object.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
Most non-register constraints should be defined with
|
|
@code{define_constraint}. The remaining two definition expressions
|
|
are only appropriate for constraints that should be handled specially
|
|
by @code{reload} if they fail to match.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {MD Expression} define_memory_constraint name docstring exp
|
|
Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all memory
|
|
operands: that is, @code{reload} can make them match by converting the
|
|
operand to the form @samp{@w{(mem (reg @var{X}))}}, where @var{X} is a
|
|
base register (from the register class specified by
|
|
@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}, @pxref{Register Classes}).
|
|
|
|
For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
|
|
memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
|
|
register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined to represent a
|
|
memory address of this type. If @samp{Q} is defined with
|
|
@code{define_memory_constraint}, a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any
|
|
memory operand, because @code{reload} knows it can simply copy the
|
|
memory address into a base register if required. This is analogous to
|
|
the way a @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
|
|
|
|
The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
|
|
@code{define_constraint}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {MD Expression} define_address_constraint name docstring exp
|
|
Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all address
|
|
operands: that is, @code{reload} can make the constraint match by
|
|
converting the operand to the form @samp{@w{(reg @var{X})}}, again
|
|
with @var{X} a base register.
|
|
|
|
Constraints defined with @code{define_address_constraint} can only be
|
|
used with the @code{address_operand} predicate, or machine-specific
|
|
predicates that work the same way. They are treated analogously to
|
|
the generic @samp{p} constraint.
|
|
|
|
The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
|
|
@code{define_constraint}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
For historical reasons, names beginning with the letters @samp{G H}
|
|
are reserved for constraints that match only @code{const_double}s, and
|
|
names beginning with the letters @samp{I J K L M N O P} are reserved
|
|
for constraints that match only @code{const_int}s. This may change in
|
|
the future. For the time being, constraints with these names must be
|
|
written in a stylized form, so that @code{genpreds} can tell you did
|
|
it correctly:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
(define_constraint "[@var{GHIJKLMNOP}]@dots{}"
|
|
"@var{doc}@dots{}"
|
|
(and (match_code "const_int") ; @r{@code{const_double} for G/H}
|
|
@var{condition}@dots{})) ; @r{usually a @code{match_test}}
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
@c the semicolons line up in the formatted manual
|
|
|
|
It is fine to use names beginning with other letters for constraints
|
|
that match @code{const_double}s or @code{const_int}s.
|
|
|
|
Each docstring in a constraint definition should be one or more complete
|
|
sentences, marked up in Texinfo format. @emph{They are currently unused.}
|
|
In the future they will be copied into the GCC manual, in @ref{Machine
|
|
Constraints}, replacing the hand-maintained tables currently found in
|
|
that section. Also, in the future the compiler may use this to give
|
|
more helpful diagnostics when poor choice of @code{asm} constraints
|
|
causes a reload failure.
|
|
|
|
If you put the pseudo-Texinfo directive @samp{@@internal} at the
|
|
beginning of a docstring, then (in the future) it will appear only in
|
|
the internals manual's version of the machine-specific constraint tables.
|
|
Use this for constraints that should not appear in @code{asm} statements.
|
|
|
|
@node C Constraint Interface
|
|
@subsection Testing constraints from C
|
|
@cindex testing constraints
|
|
@cindex constraints, testing
|
|
|
|
It is occasionally useful to test a constraint from C code rather than
|
|
implicitly via the constraint string in a @code{match_operand}. The
|
|
generated file @file{tm_p.h} declares a few interfaces for working
|
|
with machine-specific constraints. None of these interfaces work with
|
|
the generic constraints described in @ref{Simple Constraints}. This
|
|
may change in the future.
|
|
|
|
@strong{Warning:} @file{tm_p.h} may declare other functions that
|
|
operate on constraints, besides the ones documented here. Do not use
|
|
those functions from machine-dependent code. They exist to implement
|
|
the old constraint interface that machine-independent components of
|
|
the compiler still expect. They will change or disappear in the
|
|
future.
|
|
|
|
Some valid constraint names are not valid C identifiers, so there is a
|
|
mangling scheme for referring to them from C@. Constraint names that
|
|
do not contain angle brackets or underscores are left unchanged.
|
|
Underscores are doubled, each @samp{<} is replaced with @samp{_l}, and
|
|
each @samp{>} with @samp{_g}. Here are some examples:
|
|
|
|
@c the @c's prevent double blank lines in the printed manual.
|
|
@example
|
|
@multitable {Original} {Mangled}
|
|
@item @strong{Original} @tab @strong{Mangled} @c
|
|
@item @code{x} @tab @code{x} @c
|
|
@item @code{P42x} @tab @code{P42x} @c
|
|
@item @code{P4_x} @tab @code{P4__x} @c
|
|
@item @code{P4>x} @tab @code{P4_gx} @c
|
|
@item @code{P4>>} @tab @code{P4_g_g} @c
|
|
@item @code{P4_g>} @tab @code{P4__g_g} @c
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Throughout this section, the variable @var{c} is either a constraint
|
|
in the abstract sense, or a constant from @code{enum constraint_num};
|
|
the variable @var{m} is a mangled constraint name (usually as part of
|
|
a larger identifier).
|
|
|
|
@deftp Enum constraint_num
|
|
For each machine-specific constraint, there is a corresponding
|
|
enumeration constant: @samp{CONSTRAINT_} plus the mangled name of the
|
|
constraint. Functions that take an @code{enum constraint_num} as an
|
|
argument expect one of these constants.
|
|
|
|
Machine-independent constraints do not have associated constants.
|
|
This may change in the future.
|
|
@end deftp
|
|
|
|
@deftypefun {inline bool} satisfies_constraint_@var{m} (rtx @var{exp})
|
|
For each machine-specific, non-register constraint @var{m}, there is
|
|
one of these functions; it returns @code{true} if @var{exp} satisfies the
|
|
constraint. These functions are only visible if @file{rtl.h} was included
|
|
before @file{tm_p.h}.
|
|
@end deftypefun
|
|
|
|
@deftypefun bool constraint_satisfied_p (rtx @var{exp}, enum constraint_num @var{c})
|
|
Like the @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}} functions, but the
|
|
constraint to test is given as an argument, @var{c}. If @var{c}
|
|
specifies a register constraint, this function will always return
|
|
@code{false}.
|
|
@end deftypefun
|
|
|
|
@deftypefun {enum reg_class} regclass_for_constraint (enum constraint_num @var{c})
|
|
Returns the register class associated with @var{c}. If @var{c} is not
|
|
a register constraint, or those registers are not available for the
|
|
currently selected subtarget, returns @code{NO_REGS}.
|
|
@end deftypefun
|
|
|
|
Here is an example use of @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}}. In
|
|
peephole optimizations (@pxref{Peephole Definitions}), operand
|
|
constraint strings are ignored, so if there are relevant constraints,
|
|
they must be tested in the C condition. In the example, the
|
|
optimization is applied if operand 2 does @emph{not} satisfy the
|
|
@samp{K} constraint. (This is a simplified version of a peephole
|
|
definition from the i386 machine description.)
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_peephole2
|
|
[(match_scratch:SI 3 "r")
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
|
|
(mult:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "")))]
|
|
|
|
"!satisfies_constraint_K (operands[2])"
|
|
|
|
[(set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 1))
|
|
(set (match_dup 0) (mult:SI (match_dup 3) (match_dup 2)))]
|
|
|
|
"")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@node Standard Names
|
|
@section Standard Pattern Names For Generation
|
|
@cindex standard pattern names
|
|
@cindex pattern names
|
|
@cindex names, pattern
|
|
|
|
Here is a table of the instruction names that are meaningful in the RTL
|
|
generation pass of the compiler. Giving one of these names to an
|
|
instruction pattern tells the RTL generation pass that it can use the
|
|
pattern to accomplish a certain task.
|
|
|
|
@table @asis
|
|
@cindex @code{mov@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{mov@var{m}}
|
|
Here @var{m} stands for a two-letter machine mode name, in lowercase.
|
|
This instruction pattern moves data with that machine mode from operand
|
|
1 to operand 0. For example, @samp{movsi} moves full-word data.
|
|
|
|
If operand 0 is a @code{subreg} with mode @var{m} of a register whose
|
|
own mode is wider than @var{m}, the effect of this instruction is
|
|
to store the specified value in the part of the register that corresponds
|
|
to mode @var{m}. Bits outside of @var{m}, but which are within the
|
|
same target word as the @code{subreg} are undefined. Bits which are
|
|
outside the target word are left unchanged.
|
|
|
|
This class of patterns is special in several ways. First of all, each
|
|
of these names up to and including full word size @emph{must} be defined,
|
|
because there is no other way to copy a datum from one place to another.
|
|
If there are patterns accepting operands in larger modes,
|
|
@samp{mov@var{m}} must be defined for integer modes of those sizes.
|
|
|
|
Second, these patterns are not used solely in the RTL generation pass.
|
|
Even the reload pass can generate move insns to copy values from stack
|
|
slots into temporary registers. When it does so, one of the operands is
|
|
a hard register and the other is an operand that can need to be reloaded
|
|
into a register.
|
|
|
|
@findex force_reg
|
|
Therefore, when given such a pair of operands, the pattern must generate
|
|
RTL which needs no reloading and needs no temporary registers---no
|
|
registers other than the operands. For example, if you support the
|
|
pattern with a @code{define_expand}, then in such a case the
|
|
@code{define_expand} mustn't call @code{force_reg} or any other such
|
|
function which might generate new pseudo registers.
|
|
|
|
This requirement exists even for subword modes on a RISC machine where
|
|
fetching those modes from memory normally requires several insns and
|
|
some temporary registers.
|
|
|
|
@findex change_address
|
|
During reload a memory reference with an invalid address may be passed
|
|
as an operand. Such an address will be replaced with a valid address
|
|
later in the reload pass. In this case, nothing may be done with the
|
|
address except to use it as it stands. If it is copied, it will not be
|
|
replaced with a valid address. No attempt should be made to make such
|
|
an address into a valid address and no routine (such as
|
|
@code{change_address}) that will do so may be called. Note that
|
|
@code{general_operand} will fail when applied to such an address.
|
|
|
|
@findex reload_in_progress
|
|
The global variable @code{reload_in_progress} (which must be explicitly
|
|
declared if required) can be used to determine whether such special
|
|
handling is required.
|
|
|
|
The variety of operands that have reloads depends on the rest of the
|
|
machine description, but typically on a RISC machine these can only be
|
|
pseudo registers that did not get hard registers, while on other
|
|
machines explicit memory references will get optional reloads.
|
|
|
|
If a scratch register is required to move an object to or from memory,
|
|
it can be allocated using @code{gen_reg_rtx} prior to life analysis.
|
|
|
|
If there are cases which need scratch registers during or after reload,
|
|
you must provide an appropriate secondary_reload target hook.
|
|
|
|
@findex no_new_pseudos
|
|
The global variable @code{no_new_pseudos} can be used to determine if it
|
|
is unsafe to create new pseudo registers. If this variable is nonzero, then
|
|
it is unsafe to call @code{gen_reg_rtx} to allocate a new pseudo.
|
|
|
|
The constraints on a @samp{mov@var{m}} must permit moving any hard
|
|
register to any other hard register provided that
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} permits mode @var{m} in both registers and
|
|
@code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their classes returns a value of 2.
|
|
|
|
It is obligatory to support floating point @samp{mov@var{m}}
|
|
instructions into and out of any registers that can hold fixed point
|
|
values, because unions and structures (which have modes @code{SImode} or
|
|
@code{DImode}) can be in those registers and they may have floating
|
|
point members.
|
|
|
|
There may also be a need to support fixed point @samp{mov@var{m}}
|
|
instructions in and out of floating point registers. Unfortunately, I
|
|
have forgotten why this was so, and I don't know whether it is still
|
|
true. If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} rejects fixed point values in
|
|
floating point registers, then the constraints of the fixed point
|
|
@samp{mov@var{m}} instructions must be designed to avoid ever trying to
|
|
reload into a floating point register.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{reload_in} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{reload_out} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{reload_in@var{m}}
|
|
@itemx @samp{reload_out@var{m}}
|
|
These named patterns have been obsoleted by the target hook
|
|
@code{secondary_reload}.
|
|
|
|
Like @samp{mov@var{m}}, but used when a scratch register is required to
|
|
move between operand 0 and operand 1. Operand 2 describes the scratch
|
|
register. See the discussion of the @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS}
|
|
macro in @pxref{Register Classes}.
|
|
|
|
There are special restrictions on the form of the @code{match_operand}s
|
|
used in these patterns. First, only the predicate for the reload
|
|
operand is examined, i.e., @code{reload_in} examines operand 1, but not
|
|
the predicates for operand 0 or 2. Second, there may be only one
|
|
alternative in the constraints. Third, only a single register class
|
|
letter may be used for the constraint; subsequent constraint letters
|
|
are ignored. As a special exception, an empty constraint string
|
|
matches the @code{ALL_REGS} register class. This may relieve ports
|
|
of the burden of defining an @code{ALL_REGS} constraint letter just
|
|
for these patterns.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{movstrict@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{movstrict@var{m}}
|
|
Like @samp{mov@var{m}} except that if operand 0 is a @code{subreg}
|
|
with mode @var{m} of a register whose natural mode is wider,
|
|
the @samp{movstrict@var{m}} instruction is guaranteed not to alter
|
|
any of the register except the part which belongs to mode @var{m}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{movmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{movmisalign@var{m}}
|
|
This variant of a move pattern is designed to load or store a value
|
|
from a memory address that is not naturally aligned for its mode.
|
|
For a store, the memory will be in operand 0; for a load, the memory
|
|
will be in operand 1. The other operand is guaranteed not to be a
|
|
memory, so that it's easy to tell whether this is a load or store.
|
|
|
|
This pattern is used by the autovectorizer, and when expanding a
|
|
@code{MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF} expression.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{load_multiple} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{load_multiple}
|
|
Load several consecutive memory locations into consecutive registers.
|
|
Operand 0 is the first of the consecutive registers, operand 1
|
|
is the first memory location, and operand 2 is a constant: the
|
|
number of consecutive registers.
|
|
|
|
Define this only if the target machine really has such an instruction;
|
|
do not define this if the most efficient way of loading consecutive
|
|
registers from memory is to do them one at a time.
|
|
|
|
On some machines, there are restrictions as to which consecutive
|
|
registers can be stored into memory, such as particular starting or
|
|
ending register numbers or only a range of valid counts. For those
|
|
machines, use a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
|
|
and make the pattern fail if the restrictions are not met.
|
|
|
|
Write the generated insn as a @code{parallel} with elements being a
|
|
@code{set} of one register from the appropriate memory location (you may
|
|
also need @code{use} or @code{clobber} elements). Use a
|
|
@code{match_parallel} (@pxref{RTL Template}) to recognize the insn. See
|
|
@file{rs6000.md} for examples of the use of this insn pattern.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @samp{store_multiple} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{store_multiple}
|
|
Similar to @samp{load_multiple}, but store several consecutive registers
|
|
into consecutive memory locations. Operand 0 is the first of the
|
|
consecutive memory locations, operand 1 is the first register, and
|
|
operand 2 is a constant: the number of consecutive registers.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{vec_set@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{vec_set@var{m}}
|
|
Set given field in the vector value. Operand 0 is the vector to modify,
|
|
operand 1 is new value of field and operand 2 specify the field index.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{vec_extract@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{vec_extract@var{m}}
|
|
Extract given field from the vector value. Operand 1 is the vector, operand 2
|
|
specify field index and operand 0 place to store value into.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{vec_init@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{vec_init@var{m}}
|
|
Initialize the vector to given values. Operand 0 is the vector to initialize
|
|
and operand 1 is parallel containing values for individual fields.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{push@var{m}1} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{push@var{m}1}
|
|
Output a push instruction. Operand 0 is value to push. Used only when
|
|
@code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined. For historical reason, this pattern may be
|
|
missing and in such case an @code{mov} expander is used instead, with a
|
|
@code{MEM} expression forming the push operation. The @code{mov} expander
|
|
method is deprecated.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{add@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{add@var{m}3}
|
|
Add operand 2 and operand 1, storing the result in operand 0. All operands
|
|
must have mode @var{m}. This can be used even on two-address machines, by
|
|
means of constraints requiring operands 1 and 0 to be the same location.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{mul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{div@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{udiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{mod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{umod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{umin@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{umax@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{and@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{ior@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{xor@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sub@var{m}3}, @samp{mul@var{m}3}
|
|
@itemx @samp{div@var{m}3}, @samp{udiv@var{m}3}
|
|
@itemx @samp{mod@var{m}3}, @samp{umod@var{m}3}
|
|
@itemx @samp{umin@var{m}3}, @samp{umax@var{m}3}
|
|
@itemx @samp{and@var{m}3}, @samp{ior@var{m}3}, @samp{xor@var{m}3}
|
|
Similar, for other arithmetic operations.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{min@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{max@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{smin@var{m}3}, @samp{smax@var{m}3}
|
|
Signed minimum and maximum operations. When used with floating point,
|
|
if both operands are zeros, or if either operand is @code{NaN}, then
|
|
it is unspecified which of the two operands is returned as the result.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{reduc_smin_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{reduc_smax_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{reduc_smin_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_smax_@var{m}}
|
|
Find the signed minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
|
|
operand 1, and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of
|
|
operand 0 (also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same
|
|
modes.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{reduc_umin_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{reduc_umax_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{reduc_umin_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_umax_@var{m}}
|
|
Find the unsigned minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
|
|
operand 1, and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of
|
|
operand 0 (also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same
|
|
modes.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{reduc_splus_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{reduc_splus_@var{m}}
|
|
Compute the sum of the signed elements of a vector. The vector is operand 1,
|
|
and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of operand 0
|
|
(also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same modes.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{reduc_uplus_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{reduc_uplus_@var{m}}
|
|
Compute the sum of the unsigned elements of a vector. The vector is operand 1,
|
|
and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of operand 0
|
|
(also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same modes.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sdot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sdot_prod@var{m}}
|
|
@cindex @code{udot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{udot_prod@var{m}}
|
|
Compute the sum of the products of two signed/unsigned elements.
|
|
Operand 1 and operand 2 are of the same mode. Their product, which is of a
|
|
wider mode, is computed and added to operand 3. Operand 3 is of a mode equal or
|
|
wider than the mode of the product. The result is placed in operand 0, which
|
|
is of the same mode as operand 3.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ssum_widen@var{m3}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{ssum_widen@var{m3}}
|
|
@cindex @code{usum_widen@var{m3}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{usum_widen@var{m3}}
|
|
Operands 0 and 2 are of the same mode, which is wider than the mode of
|
|
operand 1. Add operand 1 to operand 2 and place the widened result in
|
|
operand 0. (This is used express accumulation of elements into an accumulator
|
|
of a wider mode.)
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{vec_shl_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{vec_shr_@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{vec_shl_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_shr_@var{m}}
|
|
Whole vector left/right shift in bits.
|
|
Operand 1 is a vector to be shifted.
|
|
Operand 2 is an integer shift amount in bits.
|
|
Operand 0 is where the resulting shifted vector is stored.
|
|
The output and input vectors should have the same modes.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{mulhisi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{mulhisi3}
|
|
Multiply operands 1 and 2, which have mode @code{HImode}, and store
|
|
a @code{SImode} product in operand 0.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{mulqihi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{mulsidi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{mulqihi3}, @samp{mulsidi3}
|
|
Similar widening-multiplication instructions of other widths.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{umulqihi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{umulhisi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{umulsidi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{umulqihi3}, @samp{umulhisi3}, @samp{umulsidi3}
|
|
Similar widening-multiplication instructions that do unsigned
|
|
multiplication.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{usmulqihi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{usmulhisi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{usmulsidi3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{usmulqihi3}, @samp{usmulhisi3}, @samp{usmulsidi3}
|
|
Similar widening-multiplication instructions that interpret the first
|
|
operand as unsigned and the second operand as signed, then do a signed
|
|
multiplication.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{smul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{smul@var{m}3_highpart}
|
|
Perform a signed multiplication of operands 1 and 2, which have mode
|
|
@var{m}, and store the most significant half of the product in operand 0.
|
|
The least significant half of the product is discarded.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{umul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{umul@var{m}3_highpart}
|
|
Similar, but the multiplication is unsigned.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{divmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{divmod@var{m}4}
|
|
Signed division that produces both a quotient and a remainder.
|
|
Operand 1 is divided by operand 2 to produce a quotient stored
|
|
in operand 0 and a remainder stored in operand 3.
|
|
|
|
For machines with an instruction that produces both a quotient and a
|
|
remainder, provide a pattern for @samp{divmod@var{m}4} but do not
|
|
provide patterns for @samp{div@var{m}3} and @samp{mod@var{m}3}. This
|
|
allows optimization in the relatively common case when both the quotient
|
|
and remainder are computed.
|
|
|
|
If an instruction that just produces a quotient or just a remainder
|
|
exists and is more efficient than the instruction that produces both,
|
|
write the output routine of @samp{divmod@var{m}4} to call
|
|
@code{find_reg_note} and look for a @code{REG_UNUSED} note on the
|
|
quotient or remainder and generate the appropriate instruction.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{udivmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{udivmod@var{m}4}
|
|
Similar, but does unsigned division.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{shift patterns}
|
|
@cindex @code{ashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{ashl@var{m}3}
|
|
Arithmetic-shift operand 1 left by a number of bits specified by operand
|
|
2, and store the result in operand 0. Here @var{m} is the mode of
|
|
operand 0 and operand 1; operand 2's mode is specified by the
|
|
instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that
|
|
mode before generating the instruction. The meaning of out-of-range shift
|
|
counts can optionally be specified by @code{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}.
|
|
@xref{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ashr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{lshr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{rotl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{rotr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{ashr@var{m}3}, @samp{lshr@var{m}3}, @samp{rotl@var{m}3}, @samp{rotr@var{m}3}
|
|
Other shift and rotate instructions, analogous to the
|
|
@code{ashl@var{m}3} instructions.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{neg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{neg@var{m}2}
|
|
Negate operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{abs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{abs@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the absolute value of operand 1 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sqrt@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sqrt@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the square root of operand 1 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
The @code{sqrt} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{sqrtf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{cos@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{cos@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the cosine of operand 1 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
The @code{cos} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{cosf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sin@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sin@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the sine of operand 1 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
The @code{sin} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{sinf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{exp@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{exp@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the exponential of operand 1 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
The @code{exp} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{expf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{log@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{log@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the natural logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
The @code{log} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{logf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{pow@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{pow@var{m}3}
|
|
Store the value of operand 1 raised to the exponent operand 2
|
|
into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
The @code{pow} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{powf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{atan2@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{atan2@var{m}3}
|
|
Store the arc tangent (inverse tangent) of operand 1 divided by
|
|
operand 2 into operand 0, using the signs of both arguments to
|
|
determine the quadrant of the result.
|
|
|
|
The @code{atan2} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{atan2f}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{floor@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{floor@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the largest integral value not greater than argument.
|
|
|
|
The @code{floor} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{floorf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{btrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{btrunc@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the argument rounded to integer towards zero.
|
|
|
|
The @code{trunc} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{truncf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{round@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{round@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the argument rounded to integer away from zero.
|
|
|
|
The @code{round} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{roundf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ceil@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{ceil@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the argument rounded to integer away from zero.
|
|
|
|
The @code{ceil} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{ceilf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{nearbyint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{nearbyint@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the argument rounded according to the default rounding mode
|
|
|
|
The @code{nearbyint} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{nearbyintf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{rint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{rint@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the argument rounded according to the default rounding mode and
|
|
raise the inexact exception when the result differs in value from
|
|
the argument
|
|
|
|
The @code{rint} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{rintf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{copysign@var{m}3} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{copysign@var{m}3}
|
|
Store a value with the magnitude of operand 1 and the sign of operand
|
|
2 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
The @code{copysign} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{copysignf}
|
|
built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
|
|
type @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ffs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{ffs@var{m}2}
|
|
Store into operand 0 one plus the index of the least significant 1-bit
|
|
of operand 1. If operand 1 is zero, store zero. @var{m} is the mode
|
|
of operand 0; operand 1's mode is specified by the instruction
|
|
pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that mode before
|
|
generating the instruction.
|
|
|
|
The @code{ffs} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
|
|
corresponds to the C data type @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{clz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{clz@var{m}2}
|
|
Store into operand 0 the number of leading 0-bits in @var{x}, starting
|
|
at the most significant bit position. If @var{x} is 0, the result is
|
|
undefined. @var{m} is the mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode is
|
|
specified by the instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the
|
|
operand to that mode before generating the instruction.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ctz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{ctz@var{m}2}
|
|
Store into operand 0 the number of trailing 0-bits in @var{x}, starting
|
|
at the least significant bit position. If @var{x} is 0, the result is
|
|
undefined. @var{m} is the mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode is
|
|
specified by the instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the
|
|
operand to that mode before generating the instruction.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{popcount@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{popcount@var{m}2}
|
|
Store into operand 0 the number of 1-bits in @var{x}. @var{m} is the
|
|
mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode is specified by the instruction
|
|
pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that mode before
|
|
generating the instruction.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{parity@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{parity@var{m}2}
|
|
Store into operand 0 the parity of @var{x}, i.e.@: the number of 1-bits
|
|
in @var{x} modulo 2. @var{m} is the mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode
|
|
is specified by the instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert
|
|
the operand to that mode before generating the instruction.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{one_cmpl@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{one_cmpl@var{m}2}
|
|
Store the bitwise-complement of operand 1 into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{cmp@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{cmp@var{m}}
|
|
Compare operand 0 and operand 1, and set the condition codes.
|
|
The RTL pattern should look like this:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(set (cc0) (compare (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
|
|
(match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{})))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{tst@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{tst@var{m}}
|
|
Compare operand 0 against zero, and set the condition codes.
|
|
The RTL pattern should look like this:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(set (cc0) (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{}))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@samp{tst@var{m}} patterns should not be defined for machines that do
|
|
not use @code{(cc0)}. Doing so would confuse the optimizer since it
|
|
would no longer be clear which @code{set} operations were comparisons.
|
|
The @samp{cmp@var{m}} patterns should be used instead.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{movmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{movmem@var{m}}
|
|
Block move instruction. The destination and source blocks of memory
|
|
are the first two operands, and both are @code{mem:BLK}s with an
|
|
address in mode @code{Pmode}.
|
|
|
|
The number of bytes to move is the third operand, in mode @var{m}.
|
|
Usually, you specify @code{word_mode} for @var{m}. However, if you can
|
|
generate better code knowing the range of valid lengths is smaller than
|
|
those representable in a full word, you should provide a pattern with a
|
|
mode corresponding to the range of values you can handle efficiently
|
|
(e.g., @code{QImode} for values in the range 0--127; note we avoid numbers
|
|
that appear negative) and also a pattern with @code{word_mode}.
|
|
|
|
The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
|
|
destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
|
|
compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
|
|
it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
|
|
|
|
Descriptions of multiple @code{movmem@var{m}} patterns can only be
|
|
beneficial if the patterns for smaller modes have fewer restrictions
|
|
on their first, second and fourth operands. Note that the mode @var{m}
|
|
in @code{movmem@var{m}} does not impose any restriction on the mode of
|
|
individually moved data units in the block.
|
|
|
|
These patterns need not give special consideration to the possibility
|
|
that the source and destination strings might overlap.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{movstr} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{movstr}
|
|
String copy instruction, with @code{stpcpy} semantics. Operand 0 is
|
|
an output operand in mode @code{Pmode}. The addresses of the
|
|
destination and source strings are operands 1 and 2, and both are
|
|
@code{mem:BLK}s with addresses in mode @code{Pmode}. The execution of
|
|
the expansion of this pattern should store in operand 0 the address in
|
|
which the @code{NUL} terminator was stored in the destination string.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{setmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{setmem@var{m}}
|
|
Block set instruction. The destination string is the first operand,
|
|
given as a @code{mem:BLK} whose address is in mode @code{Pmode}. The
|
|
number of bytes to set is the second operand, in mode @var{m}. The value to
|
|
initialize the memory with is the third operand. Targets that only support the
|
|
clearing of memory should reject any value that is not the constant 0. See
|
|
@samp{movmem@var{m}} for a discussion of the choice of mode.
|
|
|
|
The fourth operand is the known alignment of the destination, in the form
|
|
of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the compiler knows that the
|
|
destination is word-aligned, it may provide the value 4 for this
|
|
operand.
|
|
|
|
The use for multiple @code{setmem@var{m}} is as for @code{movmem@var{m}}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{cmpstrn@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{cmpstrn@var{m}}
|
|
String compare instruction, with five operands. Operand 0 is the output;
|
|
it has mode @var{m}. The remaining four operands are like the operands
|
|
of @samp{movmem@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
|
|
byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
|
|
string. The instruction is not allowed to prefetch more than one byte
|
|
at a time since either string may end in the first byte and reading past
|
|
that may access an invalid page or segment and cause a fault. The
|
|
effect of the instruction is to store a value in operand 0 whose sign
|
|
indicates the result of the comparison.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{cmpstr@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}
|
|
String compare instruction, without known maximum length. Operand 0 is the
|
|
output; it has mode @var{m}. The second and third operand are the blocks of
|
|
memory to be compared; both are @code{mem:BLK} with an address in mode
|
|
@code{Pmode}.
|
|
|
|
The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
|
|
destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
|
|
compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
|
|
it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
|
|
|
|
The two memory blocks specified are compared byte by byte in lexicographic
|
|
order starting at the beginning of each string. The instruction is not allowed
|
|
to prefetch more than one byte at a time since either string may end in the
|
|
first byte and reading past that may access an invalid page or segment and
|
|
cause a fault. The effect of the instruction is to store a value in operand 0
|
|
whose sign indicates the result of the comparison.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{cmpmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{cmpmem@var{m}}
|
|
Block compare instruction, with five operands like the operands
|
|
of @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
|
|
byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
|
|
block. Unlike @samp{cmpstr@var{m}} the instruction can prefetch
|
|
any bytes in the two memory blocks. The effect of the instruction is
|
|
to store a value in operand 0 whose sign indicates the result of the
|
|
comparison.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{strlen@var{m}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{strlen@var{m}}
|
|
Compute the length of a string, with three operands.
|
|
Operand 0 is the result (of mode @var{m}), operand 1 is
|
|
a @code{mem} referring to the first character of the string,
|
|
operand 2 is the character to search for (normally zero),
|
|
and operand 3 is a constant describing the known alignment
|
|
of the beginning of the string.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{float@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{float@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Convert signed integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m}) to
|
|
floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
|
|
@var{n}).
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{floatuns@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{floatuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Convert unsigned integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m})
|
|
to floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
|
|
@var{n}).
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{fix@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
|
|
point mode @var{n} as a signed number and store in operand 0 (which
|
|
has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when
|
|
the value of operand 1 is an integer.
|
|
|
|
If the machine description defines this pattern, it also needs to
|
|
define the @code{ftrunc} pattern.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{fixuns@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
|
|
point mode @var{n} as an unsigned number and store in operand 0 (which
|
|
has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when the
|
|
value of operand 1 is an integer.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ftrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{ftrunc@var{m}2}
|
|
Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to an
|
|
integer value, still represented in floating point mode @var{m}, and
|
|
store it in operand 0 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}).
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{fix_trunc@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{fix_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Like @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point value
|
|
of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{fixuns_trunc@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{fixuns_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Like @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point
|
|
value of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{trunc@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Truncate operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
|
|
store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
|
|
point or both floating point.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{extend@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Sign-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
|
|
store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
|
|
point or both floating point.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{zero_extend@var{mn}2} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{zero_extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
|
|
Zero-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
|
|
store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
|
|
point.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{extv} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{extv}
|
|
Extract a bit-field from operand 1 (a register or memory operand), where
|
|
operand 2 specifies the width in bits and operand 3 the starting bit,
|
|
and store it in operand 0. Operand 0 must have mode @code{word_mode}.
|
|
Operand 1 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or @code{word_mode}; often
|
|
@code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers. Operands 2 and 3 must
|
|
be valid for @code{word_mode}.
|
|
|
|
The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
|
|
for operands 2 and 3 and the constant is never zero for operand 2.
|
|
|
|
The bit-field value is sign-extended to a full word integer
|
|
before it is stored in operand 0.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{extzv} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{extzv}
|
|
Like @samp{extv} except that the bit-field value is zero-extended.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{insv} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{insv}
|
|
Store operand 3 (which must be valid for @code{word_mode}) into a
|
|
bit-field in operand 0, where operand 1 specifies the width in bits and
|
|
operand 2 the starting bit. Operand 0 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or
|
|
@code{word_mode}; often @code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers.
|
|
Operands 1 and 2 must be valid for @code{word_mode}.
|
|
|
|
The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
|
|
for operands 1 and 2 and the constant is never zero for operand 1.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{mov@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{mov@var{mode}cc}
|
|
Conditionally move operand 2 or operand 3 into operand 0 according to the
|
|
comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is true, operand 2 is moved
|
|
into operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
|
|
|
|
The mode of the operands being compared need not be the same as the operands
|
|
being moved. Some machines, sparc64 for example, have instructions that
|
|
conditionally move an integer value based on the floating point condition
|
|
codes and vice versa.
|
|
|
|
If the machine does not have conditional move instructions, do not
|
|
define these patterns.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{add@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{add@var{mode}cc}
|
|
Similar to @samp{mov@var{mode}cc} but for conditional addition. Conditionally
|
|
move operand 2 or (operands 2 + operand 3) into operand 0 according to the
|
|
comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is true, operand 2 is moved into
|
|
operand 0, otherwise (operand 2 + operand 3) is moved.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{s@var{cond}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{s@var{cond}}
|
|
Store zero or nonzero in the operand according to the condition codes.
|
|
Value stored is nonzero iff the condition @var{cond} is true.
|
|
@var{cond} is the name of a comparison operation expression code, such
|
|
as @code{eq}, @code{lt} or @code{leu}.
|
|
|
|
You specify the mode that the operand must have when you write the
|
|
@code{match_operand} expression. The compiler automatically sees
|
|
which mode you have used and supplies an operand of that mode.
|
|
|
|
The value stored for a true condition must have 1 as its low bit, or
|
|
else must be negative. Otherwise the instruction is not suitable and
|
|
you should omit it from the machine description. You describe to the
|
|
compiler exactly which value is stored by defining the macro
|
|
@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} (@pxref{Misc}). If a description cannot be
|
|
found that can be used for all the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns, you
|
|
should omit those operations from the machine description.
|
|
|
|
These operations may fail, but should do so only in relatively
|
|
uncommon cases; if they would fail for common cases involving
|
|
integer comparisons, it is best to omit these patterns.
|
|
|
|
If these operations are omitted, the compiler will usually generate code
|
|
that copies the constant one to the target and branches around an
|
|
assignment of zero to the target. If this code is more efficient than
|
|
the potential instructions used for the @samp{s@var{cond}} pattern
|
|
followed by those required to convert the result into a 1 or a zero in
|
|
@code{SImode}, you should omit the @samp{s@var{cond}} operations from
|
|
the machine description.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{b@var{cond}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{b@var{cond}}
|
|
Conditional branch instruction. Operand 0 is a @code{label_ref} that
|
|
refers to the label to jump to. Jump if the condition codes meet
|
|
condition @var{cond}.
|
|
|
|
Some machines do not follow the model assumed here where a comparison
|
|
instruction is followed by a conditional branch instruction. In that
|
|
case, the @samp{cmp@var{m}} (and @samp{tst@var{m}}) patterns should
|
|
simply store the operands away and generate all the required insns in a
|
|
@code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) for the conditional
|
|
branch operations. All calls to expand @samp{b@var{cond}} patterns are
|
|
immediately preceded by calls to expand either a @samp{cmp@var{m}}
|
|
pattern or a @samp{tst@var{m}} pattern.
|
|
|
|
Machines that use a pseudo register for the condition code value, or
|
|
where the mode used for the comparison depends on the condition being
|
|
tested, should also use the above mechanism. @xref{Jump Patterns}.
|
|
|
|
The above discussion also applies to the @samp{mov@var{mode}cc} and
|
|
@samp{s@var{cond}} patterns.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{cbranch@var{mode}4} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{cbranch@var{mode}4}
|
|
Conditional branch instruction combined with a compare instruction.
|
|
Operand 0 is a comparison operator. Operand 1 and operand 2 are the
|
|
first and second operands of the comparison, respectively. Operand 3
|
|
is a @code{label_ref} that refers to the label to jump to.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{jump} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{jump}
|
|
A jump inside a function; an unconditional branch. Operand 0 is the
|
|
@code{label_ref} of the label to jump to. This pattern name is mandatory
|
|
on all machines.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{call} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{call}
|
|
Subroutine call instruction returning no value. Operand 0 is the
|
|
function to call; operand 1 is the number of bytes of arguments pushed
|
|
as a @code{const_int}; operand 2 is the number of registers used as
|
|
operands.
|
|
|
|
On most machines, operand 2 is not actually stored into the RTL
|
|
pattern. It is supplied for the sake of some RISC machines which need
|
|
to put this information into the assembler code; they can put it in
|
|
the RTL instead of operand 1.
|
|
|
|
Operand 0 should be a @code{mem} RTX whose address is the address of the
|
|
function. Note, however, that this address can be a @code{symbol_ref}
|
|
expression even if it would not be a legitimate memory address on the
|
|
target machine. If it is also not a valid argument for a call
|
|
instruction, the pattern for this operation should be a
|
|
@code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) that places the
|
|
address into a register and uses that register in the call instruction.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{call_value} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{call_value}
|
|
Subroutine call instruction returning a value. Operand 0 is the hard
|
|
register in which the value is returned. There are three more
|
|
operands, the same as the three operands of the @samp{call}
|
|
instruction (but with numbers increased by one).
|
|
|
|
Subroutines that return @code{BLKmode} objects use the @samp{call}
|
|
insn.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{call_pop} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{call_value_pop} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{call_pop}, @samp{call_value_pop}
|
|
Similar to @samp{call} and @samp{call_value}, except used if defined and
|
|
if @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is nonzero. They should emit a @code{parallel}
|
|
that contains both the function call and a @code{set} to indicate the
|
|
adjustment made to the frame pointer.
|
|
|
|
For machines where @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} can be nonzero, the use of these
|
|
patterns increases the number of functions for which the frame pointer
|
|
can be eliminated, if desired.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{untyped_call} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{untyped_call}
|
|
Subroutine call instruction returning a value of any type. Operand 0 is
|
|
the function to call; operand 1 is a memory location where the result of
|
|
calling the function is to be stored; operand 2 is a @code{parallel}
|
|
expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
|
|
the saving of a function return value into the result block.
|
|
|
|
This instruction pattern should be defined to support
|
|
@code{__builtin_apply} on machines where special instructions are needed
|
|
to call a subroutine with arbitrary arguments or to save the value
|
|
returned. This instruction pattern is required on machines that have
|
|
multiple registers that can hold a return value
|
|
(i.e.@: @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} is true for more than one register).
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{return} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{return}
|
|
Subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern name should be
|
|
defined only if a single instruction can do all the work of returning
|
|
from a function.
|
|
|
|
Like the @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, this pattern is also used after the
|
|
RTL generation phase. In this case it is to support machines where
|
|
multiple instructions are usually needed to return from a function, but
|
|
some class of functions only requires one instruction to implement a
|
|
return. Normally, the applicable functions are those which do not need
|
|
to save any registers or allocate stack space.
|
|
|
|
@findex reload_completed
|
|
@findex leaf_function_p
|
|
For such machines, the condition specified in this pattern should only
|
|
be true when @code{reload_completed} is nonzero and the function's
|
|
epilogue would only be a single instruction. For machines with register
|
|
windows, the routine @code{leaf_function_p} may be used to determine if
|
|
a register window push is required.
|
|
|
|
Machines that have conditional return instructions should define patterns
|
|
such as
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else (match_operator
|
|
0 "comparison_operator"
|
|
[(cc0) (const_int 0)])
|
|
(return)
|
|
(pc)))]
|
|
"@var{condition}"
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
where @var{condition} would normally be the same condition specified on the
|
|
named @samp{return} pattern.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{untyped_return} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{untyped_return}
|
|
Untyped subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern should
|
|
be defined to support @code{__builtin_return} on machines where special
|
|
instructions are needed to return a value of any type.
|
|
|
|
Operand 0 is a memory location where the result of calling a function
|
|
with @code{__builtin_apply} is stored; operand 1 is a @code{parallel}
|
|
expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
|
|
the restoring of a function return value from the result block.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{nop} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{nop}
|
|
No-op instruction. This instruction pattern name should always be defined
|
|
to output a no-op in assembler code. @code{(const_int 0)} will do as an
|
|
RTL pattern.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{indirect_jump} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{indirect_jump}
|
|
An instruction to jump to an address which is operand zero.
|
|
This pattern name is mandatory on all machines.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{casesi} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{casesi}
|
|
Instruction to jump through a dispatch table, including bounds checking.
|
|
This instruction takes five operands:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
The index to dispatch on, which has mode @code{SImode}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The lower bound for indices in the table, an integer constant.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The total range of indices in the table---the largest index
|
|
minus the smallest one (both inclusive).
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
A label that precedes the table itself.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
A label to jump to if the index has a value outside the bounds.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
The table is a @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec} inside of a
|
|
@code{jump_insn}. The number of elements in the table is one plus the
|
|
difference between the upper bound and the lower bound.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{tablejump} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{tablejump}
|
|
Instruction to jump to a variable address. This is a low-level
|
|
capability which can be used to implement a dispatch table when there
|
|
is no @samp{casesi} pattern.
|
|
|
|
This pattern requires two operands: the address or offset, and a label
|
|
which should immediately precede the jump table. If the macro
|
|
@code{CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE} evaluates to a nonzero value then the first
|
|
operand is an offset which counts from the address of the table; otherwise,
|
|
it is an absolute address to jump to. In either case, the first operand has
|
|
mode @code{Pmode}.
|
|
|
|
The @samp{tablejump} insn is always the last insn before the jump
|
|
table it uses. Its assembler code normally has no need to use the
|
|
second operand, but you should incorporate it in the RTL pattern so
|
|
that the jump optimizer will not delete the table as unreachable code.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{decrement_and_branch_until_zero} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero}
|
|
Conditional branch instruction that decrements a register and
|
|
jumps if the register is nonzero. Operand 0 is the register to
|
|
decrement and test; operand 1 is the label to jump to if the
|
|
register is nonzero. @xref{Looping Patterns}.
|
|
|
|
This optional instruction pattern is only used by the combiner,
|
|
typically for loops reversed by the loop optimizer when strength
|
|
reduction is enabled.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{doloop_end} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{doloop_end}
|
|
Conditional branch instruction that decrements a register and jumps if
|
|
the register is nonzero. This instruction takes five operands: Operand
|
|
0 is the register to decrement and test; operand 1 is the number of loop
|
|
iterations as a @code{const_int} or @code{const0_rtx} if this cannot be
|
|
determined until run-time; operand 2 is the actual or estimated maximum
|
|
number of iterations as a @code{const_int}; operand 3 is the number of
|
|
enclosed loops as a @code{const_int} (an innermost loop has a value of
|
|
1); operand 4 is the label to jump to if the register is nonzero.
|
|
@xref{Looping Patterns}.
|
|
|
|
This optional instruction pattern should be defined for machines with
|
|
low-overhead looping instructions as the loop optimizer will try to
|
|
modify suitable loops to utilize it. If nested low-overhead looping is
|
|
not supported, use a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
|
|
and make the pattern fail if operand 3 is not @code{const1_rtx}.
|
|
Similarly, if the actual or estimated maximum number of iterations is
|
|
too large for this instruction, make it fail.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{doloop_begin} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{doloop_begin}
|
|
Companion instruction to @code{doloop_end} required for machines that
|
|
need to perform some initialization, such as loading special registers
|
|
used by a low-overhead looping instruction. If initialization insns do
|
|
not always need to be emitted, use a @code{define_expand}
|
|
(@pxref{Expander Definitions}) and make it fail.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare}
|
|
Canonicalize the function pointer in operand 1 and store the result
|
|
into operand 0.
|
|
|
|
Operand 0 is always a @code{reg} and has mode @code{Pmode}; operand 1
|
|
may be a @code{reg}, @code{mem}, @code{symbol_ref}, @code{const_int}, etc
|
|
and also has mode @code{Pmode}.
|
|
|
|
Canonicalization of a function pointer usually involves computing
|
|
the address of the function which would be called if the function
|
|
pointer were used in an indirect call.
|
|
|
|
Only define this pattern if function pointers on the target machine
|
|
can have different values but still call the same function when
|
|
used in an indirect call.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{save_stack_block} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{save_stack_function} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{save_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{restore_stack_block} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{restore_stack_function} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{restore_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{save_stack_block}
|
|
@itemx @samp{save_stack_function}
|
|
@itemx @samp{save_stack_nonlocal}
|
|
@itemx @samp{restore_stack_block}
|
|
@itemx @samp{restore_stack_function}
|
|
@itemx @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal}
|
|
Most machines save and restore the stack pointer by copying it to or
|
|
from an object of mode @code{Pmode}. Do not define these patterns on
|
|
such machines.
|
|
|
|
Some machines require special handling for stack pointer saves and
|
|
restores. On those machines, define the patterns corresponding to the
|
|
non-standard cases by using a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander
|
|
Definitions}) that produces the required insns. The three types of
|
|
saves and restores are:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{save_stack_block} saves the stack pointer at the start of a block
|
|
that allocates a variable-sized object, and @samp{restore_stack_block}
|
|
restores the stack pointer when the block is exited.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{save_stack_function} and @samp{restore_stack_function} do a
|
|
similar job for the outermost block of a function and are used when the
|
|
function allocates variable-sized objects or calls @code{alloca}. Only
|
|
the epilogue uses the restored stack pointer, allowing a simpler save or
|
|
restore sequence on some machines.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{save_stack_nonlocal} is used in functions that contain labels
|
|
branched to by nested functions. It saves the stack pointer in such a
|
|
way that the inner function can use @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} to
|
|
restore the stack pointer. The compiler generates code to restore the
|
|
frame and argument pointer registers, but some machines require saving
|
|
and restoring additional data such as register window information or
|
|
stack backchains. Place insns in these patterns to save and restore any
|
|
such required data.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
When saving the stack pointer, operand 0 is the save area and operand 1
|
|
is the stack pointer. The mode used to allocate the save area defaults
|
|
to @code{Pmode} but you can override that choice by defining the
|
|
@code{STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE} macro (@pxref{Storage Layout}). You must
|
|
specify an integral mode, or @code{VOIDmode} if no save area is needed
|
|
for a particular type of save (either because no save is needed or
|
|
because a machine-specific save area can be used). Operand 0 is the
|
|
stack pointer and operand 1 is the save area for restore operations. If
|
|
@samp{save_stack_block} is defined, operand 0 must not be
|
|
@code{VOIDmode} since these saves can be arbitrarily nested.
|
|
|
|
A save area is a @code{mem} that is at a constant offset from
|
|
@code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx} when the stack pointer is saved for use by
|
|
nonlocal gotos and a @code{reg} in the other two cases.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{allocate_stack} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{allocate_stack}
|
|
Subtract (or add if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is undefined) operand 1 from
|
|
the stack pointer to create space for dynamically allocated data.
|
|
|
|
Store the resultant pointer to this space into operand 0. If you
|
|
are allocating space from the main stack, do this by emitting a
|
|
move insn to copy @code{virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx} to operand 0.
|
|
If you are allocating the space elsewhere, generate code to copy the
|
|
location of the space to operand 0. In the latter case, you must
|
|
ensure this space gets freed when the corresponding space on the main
|
|
stack is free.
|
|
|
|
Do not define this pattern if all that must be done is the subtraction.
|
|
Some machines require other operations such as stack probes or
|
|
maintaining the back chain. Define this pattern to emit those
|
|
operations in addition to updating the stack pointer.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{check_stack} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{check_stack}
|
|
If stack checking cannot be done on your system by probing the stack with
|
|
a load or store instruction (@pxref{Stack Checking}), define this pattern
|
|
to perform the needed check and signaling an error if the stack
|
|
has overflowed. The single operand is the location in the stack furthest
|
|
from the current stack pointer that you need to validate. Normally,
|
|
on machines where this pattern is needed, you would obtain the stack
|
|
limit from a global or thread-specific variable or register.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{nonlocal_goto} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{nonlocal_goto}
|
|
Emit code to generate a non-local goto, e.g., a jump from one function
|
|
to a label in an outer function. This pattern has four arguments,
|
|
each representing a value to be used in the jump. The first
|
|
argument is to be loaded into the frame pointer, the second is
|
|
the address to branch to (code to dispatch to the actual label),
|
|
the third is the address of a location where the stack is saved,
|
|
and the last is the address of the label, to be placed in the
|
|
location for the incoming static chain.
|
|
|
|
On most machines you need not define this pattern, since GCC will
|
|
already generate the correct code, which is to load the frame pointer
|
|
and static chain, restore the stack (using the
|
|
@samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} pattern, if defined), and jump indirectly
|
|
to the dispatcher. You need only define this pattern if this code will
|
|
not work on your machine.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{nonlocal_goto_receiver} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{nonlocal_goto_receiver}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the target of a
|
|
nonlocal goto after the code already generated by GCC@. You will not
|
|
normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you might
|
|
need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global table,
|
|
must be restored when the frame pointer is restored. Note that a nonlocal
|
|
goto only occurs within a unit-of-translation, so a global table pointer
|
|
that is shared by all functions of a given module need not be restored.
|
|
There are no arguments.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{exception_receiver} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{exception_receiver}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of an
|
|
exception handler that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
|
|
will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
|
|
might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
|
|
table, must be restored after control flow is branched to the handler of
|
|
an exception. There are no arguments.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_setup} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{builtin_setjmp_setup}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, contains additional code needed to initialize
|
|
the @code{jmp_buf}. You will not normally need to define this pattern.
|
|
A typical reason why you might need this pattern is if some value, such
|
|
as a pointer to a global table, must be restored. Though it is
|
|
preferred that the pointer value be recalculated if possible (given the
|
|
address of a label for instance). The single argument is a pointer to
|
|
the @code{jmp_buf}. Note that the buffer is five words long and that
|
|
the first three are normally used by the generic mechanism.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_receiver} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{builtin_setjmp_receiver}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of an
|
|
built-in setjmp that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
|
|
will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
|
|
might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
|
|
table, must be restored. It takes one argument, which is the label
|
|
to which builtin_longjmp transfered control; this pattern may be emitted
|
|
at a small offset from that label.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{builtin_longjmp} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{builtin_longjmp}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, performs the entire action of the longjmp.
|
|
You will not normally need to define this pattern unless you also define
|
|
@code{builtin_setjmp_setup}. The single argument is a pointer to the
|
|
@code{jmp_buf}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{eh_return} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{eh_return}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, affects the way @code{__builtin_eh_return},
|
|
and thence the call frame exception handling library routines, are
|
|
built. It is intended to handle non-trivial actions needed along
|
|
the abnormal return path.
|
|
|
|
The address of the exception handler to which the function should return
|
|
is passed as operand to this pattern. It will normally need to copied by
|
|
the pattern to some special register or memory location.
|
|
If the pattern needs to determine the location of the target call
|
|
frame in order to do so, it may use @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX},
|
|
if defined; it will have already been assigned.
|
|
|
|
If this pattern is not defined, the default action will be to simply
|
|
copy the return address to @code{EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX}. Either
|
|
that macro or this pattern needs to be defined if call frame exception
|
|
handling is to be used.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{prologue} instruction pattern
|
|
@anchor{prologue instruction pattern}
|
|
@item @samp{prologue}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for entry to a function. The function
|
|
entry is responsible for setting up the stack frame, initializing the frame
|
|
pointer register, saving callee saved registers, etc.
|
|
|
|
Using a prologue pattern is generally preferred over defining
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} to emit assembly code for the prologue.
|
|
|
|
The @code{prologue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
|
|
instruction scheduling.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{epilogue} instruction pattern
|
|
@anchor{epilogue instruction pattern}
|
|
@item @samp{epilogue}
|
|
This pattern emits RTL for exit from a function. The function
|
|
exit is responsible for deallocating the stack frame, restoring callee saved
|
|
registers and emitting the return instruction.
|
|
|
|
Using an epilogue pattern is generally preferred over defining
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to emit assembly code for the epilogue.
|
|
|
|
The @code{epilogue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
|
|
instruction scheduling or which have delay slots for their return instruction.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sibcall_epilogue} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sibcall_epilogue}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for exit from a function without the final
|
|
branch back to the calling function. This pattern will be emitted before any
|
|
sibling call (aka tail call) sites.
|
|
|
|
The @code{sibcall_epilogue} pattern must not clobber any arguments used for
|
|
parameter passing or any stack slots for arguments passed to the current
|
|
function.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{trap} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{trap}
|
|
This pattern, if defined, signals an error, typically by causing some
|
|
kind of signal to be raised. Among other places, it is used by the Java
|
|
front end to signal `invalid array index' exceptions.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{conditional_trap} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{conditional_trap}
|
|
Conditional trap instruction. Operand 0 is a piece of RTL which
|
|
performs a comparison. Operand 1 is the trap code, an integer.
|
|
|
|
A typical @code{conditional_trap} pattern looks like
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "conditional_trap"
|
|
[(trap_if (match_operator 0 "trap_operator"
|
|
[(cc0) (const_int 0)])
|
|
(match_operand 1 "const_int_operand" "i"))]
|
|
""
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{prefetch} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{prefetch}
|
|
|
|
This pattern, if defined, emits code for a non-faulting data prefetch
|
|
instruction. Operand 0 is the address of the memory to prefetch. Operand 1
|
|
is a constant 1 if the prefetch is preparing for a write to the memory
|
|
address, or a constant 0 otherwise. Operand 2 is the expected degree of
|
|
temporal locality of the data and is a value between 0 and 3, inclusive; 0
|
|
means that the data has no temporal locality, so it need not be left in the
|
|
cache after the access; 3 means that the data has a high degree of temporal
|
|
locality and should be left in all levels of cache possible; 1 and 2 mean,
|
|
respectively, a low or moderate degree of temporal locality.
|
|
|
|
Targets that do not support write prefetches or locality hints can ignore
|
|
the values of operands 1 and 2.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{memory_barrier} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{memory_barrier}
|
|
|
|
If the target memory model is not fully synchronous, then this pattern
|
|
should be defined to an instruction that orders both loads and stores
|
|
before the instruction with respect to loads and stores after the instruction.
|
|
This pattern has no operands.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}
|
|
|
|
This pattern, if defined, emits code for an atomic compare-and-swap
|
|
operation. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
|
|
performed. Operand 2 is the ``old'' value to be compared against the
|
|
current contents of the memory location. Operand 3 is the ``new'' value
|
|
to store in the memory if the compare succeeds. Operand 0 is the result
|
|
of the operation; it should contain the contents of the memory
|
|
before the operation. If the compare succeeds, this should obviously be
|
|
a copy of operand 2.
|
|
|
|
This pattern must show that both operand 0 and operand 1 are modified.
|
|
|
|
This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
|
|
memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
|
|
operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
|
|
after the atomic operation.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_compare_and_swap_cc@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sync_compare_and_swap_cc@var{mode}}
|
|
|
|
This pattern is just like @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}, except
|
|
it should act as if compare part of the compare-and-swap were issued via
|
|
@code{cmp@var{m}}. This comparison will only be used with @code{EQ} and
|
|
@code{NE} branches and @code{setcc} operations.
|
|
|
|
Some targets do expose the success or failure of the compare-and-swap
|
|
operation via the status flags. Ideally we wouldn't need a separate
|
|
named pattern in order to take advantage of this, but the combine pass
|
|
does not handle patterns with multiple sets, which is required by
|
|
definition for @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sync_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_sub@var{mode}}
|
|
@itemx @samp{sync_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_and@var{mode}}
|
|
@itemx @samp{sync_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_nand@var{mode}}
|
|
|
|
These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory.
|
|
Operand 0 is the memory on which the atomic operation is performed.
|
|
Operand 1 is the second operand to the binary operator.
|
|
|
|
The ``nand'' operation is @code{~op0 & op1}.
|
|
|
|
This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
|
|
memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
|
|
operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
|
|
after the atomic operation.
|
|
|
|
If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
|
|
from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_old_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_old_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_old_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_old_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_old_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_old_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sync_old_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_sub@var{mode}}
|
|
@itemx @samp{sync_old_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_and@var{mode}}
|
|
@itemx @samp{sync_old_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_nand@var{mode}}
|
|
|
|
These patterns are emit code for an atomic operation on memory,
|
|
and return the value that the memory contained before the operation.
|
|
Operand 0 is the result value, operand 1 is the memory on which the
|
|
atomic operation is performed, and operand 2 is the second operand
|
|
to the binary operator.
|
|
|
|
This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
|
|
memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
|
|
operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
|
|
after the atomic operation.
|
|
|
|
If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
|
|
from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_new_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_new_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_new_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_new_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_new_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_new_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sync_new_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_sub@var{mode}}
|
|
@itemx @samp{sync_new_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_and@var{mode}}
|
|
@itemx @samp{sync_new_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_nand@var{mode}}
|
|
|
|
These patterns are like their @code{sync_old_@var{op}} counterparts,
|
|
except that they return the value that exists in the memory location
|
|
after the operation, rather than before the operation.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}
|
|
|
|
This pattern takes two forms, based on the capabilities of the target.
|
|
In either case, operand 0 is the result of the operand, operand 1 is
|
|
the memory on which the atomic operation is performed, and operand 2
|
|
is the value to set in the lock.
|
|
|
|
In the ideal case, this operation is an atomic exchange operation, in
|
|
which the previous value in memory operand is copied into the result
|
|
operand, and the value operand is stored in the memory operand.
|
|
|
|
For less capable targets, any value operand that is not the constant 1
|
|
should be rejected with @code{FAIL}. In this case the target may use
|
|
an atomic test-and-set bit operation. The result operand should contain
|
|
1 if the bit was previously set and 0 if the bit was previously clear.
|
|
The true contents of the memory operand are implementation defined.
|
|
|
|
This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
|
|
pattern as a whole acts as an acquire barrier, that is all memory
|
|
operations after the pattern do not occur until the lock is acquired.
|
|
|
|
If this pattern is not defined, the operation will be constructed from
|
|
a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{sync_lock_release@var{mode}} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{sync_lock_release@var{mode}}
|
|
|
|
This pattern, if defined, releases a lock set by
|
|
@code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}. Operand 0 is the memory
|
|
that contains the lock; operand 1 is the value to store in the lock.
|
|
|
|
If the target doesn't implement full semantics for
|
|
@code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}, any value operand which is not
|
|
the constant 0 should be rejected with @code{FAIL}, and the true contents
|
|
of the memory operand are implementation defined.
|
|
|
|
This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
|
|
pattern as a whole acts as a release barrier, that is the lock is
|
|
released only after all previous memory operations have completed.
|
|
|
|
If this pattern is not defined, then a @code{memory_barrier} pattern
|
|
will be emitted, followed by a store of the value to the memory operand.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{stack_protect_set} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{stack_protect_set}
|
|
|
|
This pattern, if defined, moves a @code{Pmode} value from the memory
|
|
in operand 1 to the memory in operand 0 without leaving the value in
|
|
a register afterward. This is to avoid leaking the value some place
|
|
that an attacker might use to rewrite the stack guard slot after
|
|
having clobbered it.
|
|
|
|
If this pattern is not defined, then a plain move pattern is generated.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{stack_protect_test} instruction pattern
|
|
@item @samp{stack_protect_test}
|
|
|
|
This pattern, if defined, compares a @code{Pmode} value from the
|
|
memory in operand 1 with the memory in operand 0 without leaving the
|
|
value in a register afterward and branches to operand 2 if the values
|
|
weren't equal.
|
|
|
|
If this pattern is not defined, then a plain compare pattern and
|
|
conditional branch pattern is used.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@c Each of the following nodes are wrapped in separate
|
|
@c "@ifset INTERNALS" to work around memory limits for the default
|
|
@c configuration in older tetex distributions. Known to not work:
|
|
@c tetex-1.0.7, known to work: tetex-2.0.2.
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Pattern Ordering
|
|
@section When the Order of Patterns Matters
|
|
@cindex Pattern Ordering
|
|
@cindex Ordering of Patterns
|
|
|
|
Sometimes an insn can match more than one instruction pattern. Then the
|
|
pattern that appears first in the machine description is the one used.
|
|
Therefore, more specific patterns (patterns that will match fewer things)
|
|
and faster instructions (those that will produce better code when they
|
|
do match) should usually go first in the description.
|
|
|
|
In some cases the effect of ordering the patterns can be used to hide
|
|
a pattern when it is not valid. For example, the 68000 has an
|
|
instruction for converting a fullword to floating point and another
|
|
for converting a byte to floating point. An instruction converting
|
|
an integer to floating point could match either one. We put the
|
|
pattern to convert the fullword first to make sure that one will
|
|
be used rather than the other. (Otherwise a large integer might
|
|
be generated as a single-byte immediate quantity, which would not work.)
|
|
Instead of using this pattern ordering it would be possible to make the
|
|
pattern for convert-a-byte smart enough to deal properly with any
|
|
constant value.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Dependent Patterns
|
|
@section Interdependence of Patterns
|
|
@cindex Dependent Patterns
|
|
@cindex Interdependence of Patterns
|
|
|
|
Every machine description must have a named pattern for each of the
|
|
conditional branch names @samp{b@var{cond}}. The recognition template
|
|
must always have the form
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else (@var{cond} (cc0) (const_int 0))
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 0 "" ""))
|
|
(pc)))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
In addition, every machine description must have an anonymous pattern
|
|
for each of the possible reverse-conditional branches. Their templates
|
|
look like
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else (@var{cond} (cc0) (const_int 0))
|
|
(pc)
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 0 "" ""))))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
They are necessary because jump optimization can turn direct-conditional
|
|
branches into reverse-conditional branches.
|
|
|
|
It is often convenient to use the @code{match_operator} construct to
|
|
reduce the number of patterns that must be specified for branches. For
|
|
example,
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else (match_operator 0 "comparison_operator"
|
|
[(cc0) (const_int 0)])
|
|
(pc)
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))))]
|
|
"@var{condition}"
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
In some cases machines support instructions identical except for the
|
|
machine mode of one or more operands. For example, there may be
|
|
``sign-extend halfword'' and ``sign-extend byte'' instructions whose
|
|
patterns are
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
|
|
(extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 @dots{})))
|
|
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
|
|
(extend:SI (match_operand:QI 1 @dots{})))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Constant integers do not specify a machine mode, so an instruction to
|
|
extend a constant value could match either pattern. The pattern it
|
|
actually will match is the one that appears first in the file. For correct
|
|
results, this must be the one for the widest possible mode (@code{HImode},
|
|
here). If the pattern matches the @code{QImode} instruction, the results
|
|
will be incorrect if the constant value does not actually fit that mode.
|
|
|
|
Such instructions to extend constants are rarely generated because they are
|
|
optimized away, but they do occasionally happen in nonoptimized
|
|
compilations.
|
|
|
|
If a constraint in a pattern allows a constant, the reload pass may
|
|
replace a register with a constant permitted by the constraint in some
|
|
cases. Similarly for memory references. Because of this substitution,
|
|
you should not provide separate patterns for increment and decrement
|
|
instructions. Instead, they should be generated from the same pattern
|
|
that supports register-register add insns by examining the operands and
|
|
generating the appropriate machine instruction.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Jump Patterns
|
|
@section Defining Jump Instruction Patterns
|
|
@cindex jump instruction patterns
|
|
@cindex defining jump instruction patterns
|
|
|
|
For most machines, GCC assumes that the machine has a condition code.
|
|
A comparison insn sets the condition code, recording the results of both
|
|
signed and unsigned comparison of the given operands. A separate branch
|
|
insn tests the condition code and branches or not according its value.
|
|
The branch insns come in distinct signed and unsigned flavors. Many
|
|
common machines, such as the VAX, the 68000 and the 32000, work this
|
|
way.
|
|
|
|
Some machines have distinct signed and unsigned compare instructions, and
|
|
only one set of conditional branch instructions. The easiest way to handle
|
|
these machines is to treat them just like the others until the final stage
|
|
where assembly code is written. At this time, when outputting code for the
|
|
compare instruction, peek ahead at the following branch using
|
|
@code{next_cc0_user (insn)}. (The variable @code{insn} refers to the insn
|
|
being output, in the output-writing code in an instruction pattern.) If
|
|
the RTL says that is an unsigned branch, output an unsigned compare;
|
|
otherwise output a signed compare. When the branch itself is output, you
|
|
can treat signed and unsigned branches identically.
|
|
|
|
The reason you can do this is that GCC always generates a pair of
|
|
consecutive RTL insns, possibly separated by @code{note} insns, one to
|
|
set the condition code and one to test it, and keeps the pair inviolate
|
|
until the end.
|
|
|
|
To go with this technique, you must define the machine-description macro
|
|
@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} to do @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}; in other words, no
|
|
compare instruction is superfluous.
|
|
|
|
Some machines have compare-and-branch instructions and no condition code.
|
|
A similar technique works for them. When it is time to ``output'' a
|
|
compare instruction, record its operands in two static variables. When
|
|
outputting the branch-on-condition-code instruction that follows, actually
|
|
output a compare-and-branch instruction that uses the remembered operands.
|
|
|
|
It also works to define patterns for compare-and-branch instructions.
|
|
In optimizing compilation, the pair of compare and branch instructions
|
|
will be combined according to these patterns. But this does not happen
|
|
if optimization is not requested. So you must use one of the solutions
|
|
above in addition to any special patterns you define.
|
|
|
|
In many RISC machines, most instructions do not affect the condition
|
|
code and there may not even be a separate condition code register. On
|
|
these machines, the restriction that the definition and use of the
|
|
condition code be adjacent insns is not necessary and can prevent
|
|
important optimizations. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there is a
|
|
delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set three
|
|
instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
|
|
scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
|
|
separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
|
|
|
|
On these machines, do not use @code{(cc0)}, but instead use a register
|
|
to represent the condition code. If there is a specific condition code
|
|
register in the machine, use a hard register. If the condition code or
|
|
comparison result can be placed in any general register, or if there are
|
|
multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
|
|
|
|
@findex prev_cc0_setter
|
|
@findex next_cc0_user
|
|
On some machines, the type of branch instruction generated may depend on
|
|
the way the condition code was produced; for example, on the 68k and
|
|
SPARC, setting the condition code directly from an add or subtract
|
|
instruction does not clear the overflow bit the way that a test
|
|
instruction does, so a different branch instruction must be used for
|
|
some conditional branches. For machines that use @code{(cc0)}, the set
|
|
and use of the condition code must be adjacent (separated only by
|
|
@code{note} insns) allowing flags in @code{cc_status} to be used.
|
|
(@xref{Condition Code}.) Also, the comparison and branch insns can be
|
|
located from each other by using the functions @code{prev_cc0_setter}
|
|
and @code{next_cc0_user}.
|
|
|
|
However, this is not true on machines that do not use @code{(cc0)}. On
|
|
those machines, no assumptions can be made about the adjacency of the
|
|
compare and branch insns and the above methods cannot be used. Instead,
|
|
we use the machine mode of the condition code register to record
|
|
different formats of the condition code register.
|
|
|
|
Registers used to store the condition code value should have a mode that
|
|
is in class @code{MODE_CC}. Normally, it will be @code{CCmode}. If
|
|
additional modes are required (as for the add example mentioned above in
|
|
the SPARC), define them in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}
|
|
(@pxref{Condition Code}). Also define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
|
|
a mode given an operand of a compare.
|
|
|
|
If it is known during RTL generation that a different mode will be
|
|
required (for example, if the machine has separate compare instructions
|
|
for signed and unsigned quantities, like most IBM processors), they can
|
|
be specified at that time.
|
|
|
|
If the cases that require different modes would be made by instruction
|
|
combination, the macro @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} determines which machine
|
|
mode should be used for the comparison result. The patterns should be
|
|
written using that mode. To support the case of the add on the SPARC
|
|
discussed above, we have the pattern
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
|
|
(compare:CC_NOOV
|
|
(plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
|
|
(const_int 0)))]
|
|
""
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} macro on the SPARC returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
|
|
for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Looping Patterns
|
|
@section Defining Looping Instruction Patterns
|
|
@cindex looping instruction patterns
|
|
@cindex defining looping instruction patterns
|
|
|
|
Some machines have special jump instructions that can be utilized to
|
|
make loops more efficient. A common example is the 68000 @samp{dbra}
|
|
instruction which performs a decrement of a register and a branch if the
|
|
result was greater than zero. Other machines, in particular digital
|
|
signal processors (DSPs), have special block repeat instructions to
|
|
provide low-overhead loop support. For example, the TI TMS320C3x/C4x
|
|
DSPs have a block repeat instruction that loads special registers to
|
|
mark the top and end of a loop and to count the number of loop
|
|
iterations. This avoids the need for fetching and executing a
|
|
@samp{dbra}-like instruction and avoids pipeline stalls associated with
|
|
the jump.
|
|
|
|
GCC has three special named patterns to support low overhead looping.
|
|
They are @samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero}, @samp{doloop_begin},
|
|
and @samp{doloop_end}. The first pattern,
|
|
@samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero}, is not emitted during RTL
|
|
generation but may be emitted during the instruction combination phase.
|
|
This requires the assistance of the loop optimizer, using information
|
|
collected during strength reduction, to reverse a loop to count down to
|
|
zero. Some targets also require the loop optimizer to add a
|
|
@code{REG_NONNEG} note to indicate that the iteration count is always
|
|
positive. This is needed if the target performs a signed loop
|
|
termination test. For example, the 68000 uses a pattern similar to the
|
|
following for its @code{dbra} instruction:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
(define_insn "decrement_and_branch_until_zero"
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else
|
|
(ge (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "+d*am")
|
|
(const_int -1))
|
|
(const_int 0))
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))
|
|
(pc)))
|
|
(set (match_dup 0)
|
|
(plus:SI (match_dup 0)
|
|
(const_int -1)))]
|
|
"find_reg_note (insn, REG_NONNEG, 0)"
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Note that since the insn is both a jump insn and has an output, it must
|
|
deal with its own reloads, hence the `m' constraints. Also note that
|
|
since this insn is generated by the instruction combination phase
|
|
combining two sequential insns together into an implicit parallel insn,
|
|
the iteration counter needs to be biased by the same amount as the
|
|
decrement operation, in this case @minus{}1. Note that the following similar
|
|
pattern will not be matched by the combiner.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
(define_insn "decrement_and_branch_until_zero"
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else
|
|
(ge (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "+d*am")
|
|
(const_int 1))
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))
|
|
(pc)))
|
|
(set (match_dup 0)
|
|
(plus:SI (match_dup 0)
|
|
(const_int -1)))]
|
|
"find_reg_note (insn, REG_NONNEG, 0)"
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The other two special looping patterns, @samp{doloop_begin} and
|
|
@samp{doloop_end}, are emitted by the loop optimizer for certain
|
|
well-behaved loops with a finite number of loop iterations using
|
|
information collected during strength reduction.
|
|
|
|
The @samp{doloop_end} pattern describes the actual looping instruction
|
|
(or the implicit looping operation) and the @samp{doloop_begin} pattern
|
|
is an optional companion pattern that can be used for initialization
|
|
needed for some low-overhead looping instructions.
|
|
|
|
Note that some machines require the actual looping instruction to be
|
|
emitted at the top of the loop (e.g., the TMS320C3x/C4x DSPs). Emitting
|
|
the true RTL for a looping instruction at the top of the loop can cause
|
|
problems with flow analysis. So instead, a dummy @code{doloop} insn is
|
|
emitted at the end of the loop. The machine dependent reorg pass checks
|
|
for the presence of this @code{doloop} insn and then searches back to
|
|
the top of the loop, where it inserts the true looping insn (provided
|
|
there are no instructions in the loop which would cause problems). Any
|
|
additional labels can be emitted at this point. In addition, if the
|
|
desired special iteration counter register was not allocated, this
|
|
machine dependent reorg pass could emit a traditional compare and jump
|
|
instruction pair.
|
|
|
|
The essential difference between the
|
|
@samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero} and the @samp{doloop_end}
|
|
patterns is that the loop optimizer allocates an additional pseudo
|
|
register for the latter as an iteration counter. This pseudo register
|
|
cannot be used within the loop (i.e., general induction variables cannot
|
|
be derived from it), however, in many cases the loop induction variable
|
|
may become redundant and removed by the flow pass.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Insn Canonicalizations
|
|
@section Canonicalization of Instructions
|
|
@cindex canonicalization of instructions
|
|
@cindex insn canonicalization
|
|
|
|
There are often cases where multiple RTL expressions could represent an
|
|
operation performed by a single machine instruction. This situation is
|
|
most commonly encountered with logical, branch, and multiply-accumulate
|
|
instructions. In such cases, the compiler attempts to convert these
|
|
multiple RTL expressions into a single canonical form to reduce the
|
|
number of insn patterns required.
|
|
|
|
In addition to algebraic simplifications, following canonicalizations
|
|
are performed:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
For commutative and comparison operators, a constant is always made the
|
|
second operand. If a machine only supports a constant as the second
|
|
operand, only patterns that match a constant in the second operand need
|
|
be supplied.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
For associative operators, a sequence of operators will always chain
|
|
to the left; for instance, only the left operand of an integer @code{plus}
|
|
can itself be a @code{plus}. @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor},
|
|
@code{plus}, @code{mult}, @code{smin}, @code{smax}, @code{umin}, and
|
|
@code{umax} are associative when applied to integers, and sometimes to
|
|
floating-point.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@cindex @code{neg}, canonicalization of
|
|
@cindex @code{not}, canonicalization of
|
|
@cindex @code{mult}, canonicalization of
|
|
@cindex @code{plus}, canonicalization of
|
|
@cindex @code{minus}, canonicalization of
|
|
For these operators, if only one operand is a @code{neg}, @code{not},
|
|
@code{mult}, @code{plus}, or @code{minus} expression, it will be the
|
|
first operand.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
In combinations of @code{neg}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, and
|
|
@code{minus}, the @code{neg} operations (if any) will be moved inside
|
|
the operations as far as possible. For instance,
|
|
@code{(neg (mult A B))} is canonicalized as @code{(mult (neg A) B)}, but
|
|
@code{(plus (mult (neg A) B) C)} is canonicalized as
|
|
@code{(minus A (mult B C))}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{compare}, canonicalization of
|
|
@item
|
|
For the @code{compare} operator, a constant is always the second operand
|
|
on machines where @code{cc0} is used (@pxref{Jump Patterns}). On other
|
|
machines, there are rare cases where the compiler might want to construct
|
|
a @code{compare} with a constant as the first operand. However, these
|
|
cases are not common enough for it to be worthwhile to provide a pattern
|
|
matching a constant as the first operand unless the machine actually has
|
|
such an instruction.
|
|
|
|
An operand of @code{neg}, @code{not}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, or
|
|
@code{minus} is made the first operand under the same conditions as
|
|
above.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@code{(minus @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))} is converted to
|
|
@code{(plus @var{x} (const_int @var{-n}))}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
Within address computations (i.e., inside @code{mem}), a left shift is
|
|
converted into the appropriate multiplication by a power of two.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ior}, canonicalization of
|
|
@cindex @code{and}, canonicalization of
|
|
@cindex De Morgan's law
|
|
@item
|
|
De Morgan's Law is used to move bitwise negation inside a bitwise
|
|
logical-and or logical-or operation. If this results in only one
|
|
operand being a @code{not} expression, it will be the first one.
|
|
|
|
A machine that has an instruction that performs a bitwise logical-and of one
|
|
operand with the bitwise negation of the other should specify the pattern
|
|
for that instruction as
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
|
|
(and:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
|
|
(match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{})))]
|
|
"@dots{}"
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Similarly, a pattern for a ``NAND'' instruction should be written
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
|
|
(ior:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
|
|
(not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{}))))]
|
|
"@dots{}"
|
|
"@dots{}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
In both cases, it is not necessary to include patterns for the many
|
|
logically equivalent RTL expressions.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{xor}, canonicalization of
|
|
@item
|
|
The only possible RTL expressions involving both bitwise exclusive-or
|
|
and bitwise negation are @code{(xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y})}
|
|
and @code{(not:@var{m} (xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}))}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The sum of three items, one of which is a constant, will only appear in
|
|
the form
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(plus:@var{m} (plus:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}) @var{constant})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
On machines that do not use @code{cc0},
|
|
@code{(compare @var{x} (const_int 0))} will be converted to
|
|
@var{x}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{zero_extract}, canonicalization of
|
|
@cindex @code{sign_extract}, canonicalization of
|
|
@item
|
|
Equality comparisons of a group of bits (usually a single bit) with zero
|
|
will be written using @code{zero_extract} rather than the equivalent
|
|
@code{and} or @code{sign_extract} operations.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Further canonicalization rules are defined in the function
|
|
@code{commutative_operand_precedence} in @file{gcc/rtlanal.c}.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Expander Definitions
|
|
@section Defining RTL Sequences for Code Generation
|
|
@cindex expander definitions
|
|
@cindex code generation RTL sequences
|
|
@cindex defining RTL sequences for code generation
|
|
|
|
On some target machines, some standard pattern names for RTL generation
|
|
cannot be handled with single insn, but a sequence of RTL insns can
|
|
represent them. For these target machines, you can write a
|
|
@code{define_expand} to specify how to generate the sequence of RTL@.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_expand
|
|
A @code{define_expand} is an RTL expression that looks almost like a
|
|
@code{define_insn}; but, unlike the latter, a @code{define_expand} is used
|
|
only for RTL generation and it can produce more than one RTL insn.
|
|
|
|
A @code{define_expand} RTX has four operands:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
The name. Each @code{define_expand} must have a name, since the only
|
|
use for it is to refer to it by name.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The RTL template. This is a vector of RTL expressions representing
|
|
a sequence of separate instructions. Unlike @code{define_insn}, there
|
|
is no implicit surrounding @code{PARALLEL}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The condition, a string containing a C expression. This expression is
|
|
used to express how the availability of this pattern depends on
|
|
subclasses of target machine, selected by command-line options when GCC
|
|
is run. This is just like the condition of a @code{define_insn} that
|
|
has a standard name. Therefore, the condition (if present) may not
|
|
depend on the data in the insn being matched, but only the
|
|
target-machine-type flags. The compiler needs to test these conditions
|
|
during initialization in order to learn exactly which named instructions
|
|
are available in a particular run.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The preparation statements, a string containing zero or more C
|
|
statements which are to be executed before RTL code is generated from
|
|
the RTL template.
|
|
|
|
Usually these statements prepare temporary registers for use as
|
|
internal operands in the RTL template, but they can also generate RTL
|
|
insns directly by calling routines such as @code{emit_insn}, etc.
|
|
Any such insns precede the ones that come from the RTL template.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Every RTL insn emitted by a @code{define_expand} must match some
|
|
@code{define_insn} in the machine description. Otherwise, the compiler
|
|
will crash when trying to generate code for the insn or trying to optimize
|
|
it.
|
|
|
|
The RTL template, in addition to controlling generation of RTL insns,
|
|
also describes the operands that need to be specified when this pattern
|
|
is used. In particular, it gives a predicate for each operand.
|
|
|
|
A true operand, which needs to be specified in order to generate RTL from
|
|
the pattern, should be described with a @code{match_operand} in its first
|
|
occurrence in the RTL template. This enters information on the operand's
|
|
predicate into the tables that record such things. GCC uses the
|
|
information to preload the operand into a register if that is required for
|
|
valid RTL code. If the operand is referred to more than once, subsequent
|
|
references should use @code{match_dup}.
|
|
|
|
The RTL template may also refer to internal ``operands'' which are
|
|
temporary registers or labels used only within the sequence made by the
|
|
@code{define_expand}. Internal operands are substituted into the RTL
|
|
template with @code{match_dup}, never with @code{match_operand}. The
|
|
values of the internal operands are not passed in as arguments by the
|
|
compiler when it requests use of this pattern. Instead, they are computed
|
|
within the pattern, in the preparation statements. These statements
|
|
compute the values and store them into the appropriate elements of
|
|
@code{operands} so that @code{match_dup} can find them.
|
|
|
|
There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
|
|
@code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
|
|
as a statement.
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex DONE
|
|
@item DONE
|
|
Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the pattern. The
|
|
only RTL insns resulting from the pattern on this occasion will be
|
|
those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within the
|
|
preparation statements; the RTL template will not be generated.
|
|
|
|
@findex FAIL
|
|
@item FAIL
|
|
Make the pattern fail on this occasion. When a pattern fails, it means
|
|
that the pattern was not truly available. The calling routines in the
|
|
compiler will try other strategies for code generation using other patterns.
|
|
|
|
Failure is currently supported only for binary (addition, multiplication,
|
|
shifting, etc.) and bit-field (@code{extv}, @code{extzv}, and @code{insv})
|
|
operations.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
|
|
@code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_expand} acts like a
|
|
@code{define_insn} in that the RTL template is used to generate the
|
|
insn.
|
|
|
|
The RTL template is not used for matching, only for generating the
|
|
initial insn list. If the preparation statement always invokes
|
|
@code{DONE} or @code{FAIL}, the RTL template may be reduced to a simple
|
|
list of operands, such as this example:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
(define_expand "addsi3"
|
|
[(match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "")]
|
|
@end group
|
|
@group
|
|
""
|
|
"
|
|
@{
|
|
handle_add (operands[0], operands[1], operands[2]);
|
|
DONE;
|
|
@}")
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Here is an example, the definition of left-shift for the SPUR chip:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
(define_expand "ashlsi3"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
|
|
(ashift:SI
|
|
@end group
|
|
@group
|
|
(match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "nonmemory_operand" "")))]
|
|
""
|
|
"
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
@{
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) != CONST_INT
|
|
|| (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) > 3)
|
|
FAIL;
|
|
@}")
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
This example uses @code{define_expand} so that it can generate an RTL insn
|
|
for shifting when the shift-count is in the supported range of 0 to 3 but
|
|
fail in other cases where machine insns aren't available. When it fails,
|
|
the compiler tries another strategy using different patterns (such as, a
|
|
library call).
|
|
|
|
If the compiler were able to handle nontrivial condition-strings in
|
|
patterns with names, then it would be possible to use a
|
|
@code{define_insn} in that case. Here is another case (zero-extension
|
|
on the 68000) which makes more use of the power of @code{define_expand}:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "")
|
|
(const_int 0))
|
|
(set (strict_low_part
|
|
(subreg:HI
|
|
(match_dup 0)
|
|
0))
|
|
(match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" ""))]
|
|
""
|
|
"operands[1] = make_safe_from (operands[1], operands[0]);")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@findex make_safe_from
|
|
Here two RTL insns are generated, one to clear the entire output operand
|
|
and the other to copy the input operand into its low half. This sequence
|
|
is incorrect if the input operand refers to [the old value of] the output
|
|
operand, so the preparation statement makes sure this isn't so. The
|
|
function @code{make_safe_from} copies the @code{operands[1]} into a
|
|
temporary register if it refers to @code{operands[0]}. It does this
|
|
by emitting another RTL insn.
|
|
|
|
Finally, a third example shows the use of an internal operand.
|
|
Zero-extension on the SPUR chip is done by @code{and}-ing the result
|
|
against a halfword mask. But this mask cannot be represented by a
|
|
@code{const_int} because the constant value is too large to be legitimate
|
|
on this machine. So it must be copied into a register with
|
|
@code{force_reg} and then the register used in the @code{and}.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
|
|
(and:SI (subreg:SI
|
|
(match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "")
|
|
0)
|
|
(match_dup 2)))]
|
|
""
|
|
"operands[2]
|
|
= force_reg (SImode, GEN_INT (65535)); ")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} If the @code{define_expand} is used to serve a
|
|
standard binary or unary arithmetic operation or a bit-field operation,
|
|
then the last insn it generates must not be a @code{code_label},
|
|
@code{barrier} or @code{note}. It must be an @code{insn},
|
|
@code{jump_insn} or @code{call_insn}. If you don't need a real insn
|
|
at the end, emit an insn to copy the result of the operation into
|
|
itself. Such an insn will generate no code, but it can avoid problems
|
|
in the compiler.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Insn Splitting
|
|
@section Defining How to Split Instructions
|
|
@cindex insn splitting
|
|
@cindex instruction splitting
|
|
@cindex splitting instructions
|
|
|
|
There are two cases where you should specify how to split a pattern
|
|
into multiple insns. On machines that have instructions requiring
|
|
delay slots (@pxref{Delay Slots}) or that have instructions whose
|
|
output is not available for multiple cycles (@pxref{Processor pipeline
|
|
description}), the compiler phases that optimize these cases need to
|
|
be able to move insns into one-instruction delay slots. However, some
|
|
insns may generate more than one machine instruction. These insns
|
|
cannot be placed into a delay slot.
|
|
|
|
Often you can rewrite the single insn as a list of individual insns,
|
|
each corresponding to one machine instruction. The disadvantage of
|
|
doing so is that it will cause the compilation to be slower and require
|
|
more space. If the resulting insns are too complex, it may also
|
|
suppress some optimizations. The compiler splits the insn if there is a
|
|
reason to believe that it might improve instruction or delay slot
|
|
scheduling.
|
|
|
|
The insn combiner phase also splits putative insns. If three insns are
|
|
merged into one insn with a complex expression that cannot be matched by
|
|
some @code{define_insn} pattern, the combiner phase attempts to split
|
|
the complex pattern into two insns that are recognized. Usually it can
|
|
break the complex pattern into two patterns by splitting out some
|
|
subexpression. However, in some other cases, such as performing an
|
|
addition of a large constant in two insns on a RISC machine, the way to
|
|
split the addition into two insns is machine-dependent.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_split
|
|
The @code{define_split} definition tells the compiler how to split a
|
|
complex insn into several simpler insns. It looks like this:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_split
|
|
[@var{insn-pattern}]
|
|
"@var{condition}"
|
|
[@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
|
|
@var{new-insn-pattern-2}
|
|
@dots{}]
|
|
"@var{preparation-statements}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{insn-pattern} is a pattern that needs to be split and
|
|
@var{condition} is the final condition to be tested, as in a
|
|
@code{define_insn}. When an insn matching @var{insn-pattern} and
|
|
satisfying @var{condition} is found, it is replaced in the insn list
|
|
with the insns given by @var{new-insn-pattern-1},
|
|
@var{new-insn-pattern-2}, etc.
|
|
|
|
The @var{preparation-statements} are similar to those statements that
|
|
are specified for @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
|
|
and are executed before the new RTL is generated to prepare for the
|
|
generated code or emit some insns whose pattern is not fixed. Unlike
|
|
those in @code{define_expand}, however, these statements must not
|
|
generate any new pseudo-registers. Once reload has completed, they also
|
|
must not allocate any space in the stack frame.
|
|
|
|
Patterns are matched against @var{insn-pattern} in two different
|
|
circumstances. If an insn needs to be split for delay slot scheduling
|
|
or insn scheduling, the insn is already known to be valid, which means
|
|
that it must have been matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
|
|
@code{reload_completed} is nonzero, is known to satisfy the constraints
|
|
of that @code{define_insn}. In that case, the new insn patterns must
|
|
also be insns that are matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
|
|
@code{reload_completed} is nonzero, must also satisfy the constraints
|
|
of those definitions.
|
|
|
|
As an example of this usage of @code{define_split}, consider the following
|
|
example from @file{a29k.md}, which splits a @code{sign_extend} from
|
|
@code{HImode} to @code{SImode} into a pair of shift insns:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_split
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
|
|
(sign_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")))]
|
|
""
|
|
[(set (match_dup 0)
|
|
(ashift:SI (match_dup 1)
|
|
(const_int 16)))
|
|
(set (match_dup 0)
|
|
(ashiftrt:SI (match_dup 0)
|
|
(const_int 16)))]
|
|
"
|
|
@{ operands[1] = gen_lowpart (SImode, operands[1]); @}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
When the combiner phase tries to split an insn pattern, it is always the
|
|
case that the pattern is @emph{not} matched by any @code{define_insn}.
|
|
The combiner pass first tries to split a single @code{set} expression
|
|
and then the same @code{set} expression inside a @code{parallel}, but
|
|
followed by a @code{clobber} of a pseudo-reg to use as a scratch
|
|
register. In these cases, the combiner expects exactly two new insn
|
|
patterns to be generated. It will verify that these patterns match some
|
|
@code{define_insn} definitions, so you need not do this test in the
|
|
@code{define_split} (of course, there is no point in writing a
|
|
@code{define_split} that will never produce insns that match).
|
|
|
|
Here is an example of this use of @code{define_split}, taken from
|
|
@file{rs6000.md}:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_split
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
|
|
(plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "non_add_cint_operand" "")))]
|
|
""
|
|
[(set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 3)))
|
|
(set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4)))]
|
|
"
|
|
@{
|
|
int low = INTVAL (operands[2]) & 0xffff;
|
|
int high = (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) >> 16;
|
|
|
|
if (low & 0x8000)
|
|
high++, low |= 0xffff0000;
|
|
|
|
operands[3] = GEN_INT (high << 16);
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (low);
|
|
@}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Here the predicate @code{non_add_cint_operand} matches any
|
|
@code{const_int} that is @emph{not} a valid operand of a single add
|
|
insn. The add with the smaller displacement is written so that it
|
|
can be substituted into the address of a subsequent operation.
|
|
|
|
An example that uses a scratch register, from the same file, generates
|
|
an equality comparison of a register and a large constant:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_split
|
|
[(set (match_operand:CC 0 "cc_reg_operand" "")
|
|
(compare:CC (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "non_short_cint_operand" "")))
|
|
(clobber (match_operand:SI 3 "gen_reg_operand" ""))]
|
|
"find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == EQ
|
|
|| GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == NE)"
|
|
[(set (match_dup 3) (xor:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 4)))
|
|
(set (match_dup 0) (compare:CC (match_dup 3) (match_dup 5)))]
|
|
"
|
|
@{
|
|
/* @r{Get the constant we are comparing against, C, and see what it
|
|
looks like sign-extended to 16 bits. Then see what constant
|
|
could be XOR'ed with C to get the sign-extended value.} */
|
|
|
|
int c = INTVAL (operands[2]);
|
|
int sextc = (c << 16) >> 16;
|
|
int xorv = c ^ sextc;
|
|
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (xorv);
|
|
operands[5] = GEN_INT (sextc);
|
|
@}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
To avoid confusion, don't write a single @code{define_split} that
|
|
accepts some insns that match some @code{define_insn} as well as some
|
|
insns that don't. Instead, write two separate @code{define_split}
|
|
definitions, one for the insns that are valid and one for the insns that
|
|
are not valid.
|
|
|
|
The splitter is allowed to split jump instructions into sequence of
|
|
jumps or create new jumps in while splitting non-jump instructions. As
|
|
the central flowgraph and branch prediction information needs to be updated,
|
|
several restriction apply.
|
|
|
|
Splitting of jump instruction into sequence that over by another jump
|
|
instruction is always valid, as compiler expect identical behavior of new
|
|
jump. When new sequence contains multiple jump instructions or new labels,
|
|
more assistance is needed. Splitter is required to create only unconditional
|
|
jumps, or simple conditional jump instructions. Additionally it must attach a
|
|
@code{REG_BR_PROB} note to each conditional jump. A global variable
|
|
@code{split_branch_probability} holds the probability of the original branch in case
|
|
it was an simple conditional jump, @minus{}1 otherwise. To simplify
|
|
recomputing of edge frequencies, the new sequence is required to have only
|
|
forward jumps to the newly created labels.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_insn_and_split
|
|
For the common case where the pattern of a define_split exactly matches the
|
|
pattern of a define_insn, use @code{define_insn_and_split}. It looks like
|
|
this:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn_and_split
|
|
[@var{insn-pattern}]
|
|
"@var{condition}"
|
|
"@var{output-template}"
|
|
"@var{split-condition}"
|
|
[@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
|
|
@var{new-insn-pattern-2}
|
|
@dots{}]
|
|
"@var{preparation-statements}"
|
|
[@var{insn-attributes}])
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{insn-pattern}, @var{condition}, @var{output-template}, and
|
|
@var{insn-attributes} are used as in @code{define_insn}. The
|
|
@var{new-insn-pattern} vector and the @var{preparation-statements} are used as
|
|
in a @code{define_split}. The @var{split-condition} is also used as in
|
|
@code{define_split}, with the additional behavior that if the condition starts
|
|
with @samp{&&}, the condition used for the split will be the constructed as a
|
|
logical ``and'' of the split condition with the insn condition. For example,
|
|
from i386.md:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn_and_split "zero_extendhisi2_and"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
|
|
(zero_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "0")))
|
|
(clobber (reg:CC 17))]
|
|
"TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size"
|
|
"#"
|
|
"&& reload_completed"
|
|
[(parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
|
|
(and:SI (match_dup 0) (const_int 65535)))
|
|
(clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
|
|
""
|
|
[(set_attr "type" "alu1")])
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
In this case, the actual split condition will be
|
|
@samp{TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size && reload_completed}.
|
|
|
|
The @code{define_insn_and_split} construction provides exactly the same
|
|
functionality as two separate @code{define_insn} and @code{define_split}
|
|
patterns. It exists for compactness, and as a maintenance tool to prevent
|
|
having to ensure the two patterns' templates match.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Including Patterns
|
|
@section Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
|
|
@cindex insn includes
|
|
|
|
@findex include
|
|
The @code{include} pattern tells the compiler tools where to
|
|
look for patterns that are in files other than in the file
|
|
@file{.md}. This is used only at build time and there is no preprocessing allowed.
|
|
|
|
It looks like:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(include
|
|
@var{pathname})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(include "filestuff")
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Where @var{pathname} is a string that specifies the location of the file,
|
|
specifies the include file to be in @file{gcc/config/target/filestuff}. The
|
|
directory @file{gcc/config/target} is regarded as the default directory.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Machine descriptions may be split up into smaller more manageable subsections
|
|
and placed into subdirectories.
|
|
|
|
By specifying:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(include "BOGUS/filestuff")
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
the include file is specified to be in @file{gcc/config/@var{target}/BOGUS/filestuff}.
|
|
|
|
Specifying an absolute path for the include file such as;
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(include "/u2/BOGUS/filestuff")
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
is permitted but is not encouraged.
|
|
|
|
@subsection RTL Generation Tool Options for Directory Search
|
|
@cindex directory options .md
|
|
@cindex options, directory search
|
|
@cindex search options
|
|
|
|
The @option{-I@var{dir}} option specifies directories to search for machine descriptions.
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
genrecog -I/p1/abc/proc1 -I/p2/abcd/pro2 target.md
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
|
|
searched for header files. This can be used to override a system machine definition
|
|
file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
|
|
searched before the default machine description file directories. If you use more than
|
|
one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
|
|
order; the standard default directory come after.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Peephole Definitions
|
|
@section Machine-Specific Peephole Optimizers
|
|
@cindex peephole optimizer definitions
|
|
@cindex defining peephole optimizers
|
|
|
|
In addition to instruction patterns the @file{md} file may contain
|
|
definitions of machine-specific peephole optimizations.
|
|
|
|
The combiner does not notice certain peephole optimizations when the data
|
|
flow in the program does not suggest that it should try them. For example,
|
|
sometimes two consecutive insns related in purpose can be combined even
|
|
though the second one does not appear to use a register computed in the
|
|
first one. A machine-specific peephole optimizer can detect such
|
|
opportunities.
|
|
|
|
There are two forms of peephole definitions that may be used. The
|
|
original @code{define_peephole} is run at assembly output time to
|
|
match insns and substitute assembly text. Use of @code{define_peephole}
|
|
is deprecated.
|
|
|
|
A newer @code{define_peephole2} matches insns and substitutes new
|
|
insns. The @code{peephole2} pass is run after register allocation
|
|
but before scheduling, which may result in much better code for
|
|
targets that do scheduling.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* define_peephole:: RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
|
|
* define_peephole2:: RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node define_peephole
|
|
@subsection RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
|
|
@findex define_peephole
|
|
|
|
@need 1000
|
|
A definition looks like this:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_peephole
|
|
[@var{insn-pattern-1}
|
|
@var{insn-pattern-2}
|
|
@dots{}]
|
|
"@var{condition}"
|
|
"@var{template}"
|
|
"@var{optional-insn-attributes}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The last string operand may be omitted if you are not using any
|
|
machine-specific information in this machine description. If present,
|
|
it must obey the same rules as in a @code{define_insn}.
|
|
|
|
In this skeleton, @var{insn-pattern-1} and so on are patterns to match
|
|
consecutive insns. The optimization applies to a sequence of insns when
|
|
@var{insn-pattern-1} matches the first one, @var{insn-pattern-2} matches
|
|
the next, and so on.
|
|
|
|
Each of the insns matched by a peephole must also match a
|
|
@code{define_insn}. Peepholes are checked only at the last stage just
|
|
before code generation, and only optionally. Therefore, any insn which
|
|
would match a peephole but no @code{define_insn} will cause a crash in code
|
|
generation in an unoptimized compilation, or at various optimization
|
|
stages.
|
|
|
|
The operands of the insns are matched with @code{match_operands},
|
|
@code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup}, as usual. What is not
|
|
usual is that the operand numbers apply to all the insn patterns in the
|
|
definition. So, you can check for identical operands in two insns by
|
|
using @code{match_operand} in one insn and @code{match_dup} in the
|
|
other.
|
|
|
|
The operand constraints used in @code{match_operand} patterns do not have
|
|
any direct effect on the applicability of the peephole, but they will
|
|
be validated afterward, so make sure your constraints are general enough
|
|
to apply whenever the peephole matches. If the peephole matches
|
|
but the constraints are not satisfied, the compiler will crash.
|
|
|
|
It is safe to omit constraints in all the operands of the peephole; or
|
|
you can write constraints which serve as a double-check on the criteria
|
|
previously tested.
|
|
|
|
Once a sequence of insns matches the patterns, the @var{condition} is
|
|
checked. This is a C expression which makes the final decision whether to
|
|
perform the optimization (we do so if the expression is nonzero). If
|
|
@var{condition} is omitted (in other words, the string is empty) then the
|
|
optimization is applied to every sequence of insns that matches the
|
|
patterns.
|
|
|
|
The defined peephole optimizations are applied after register allocation
|
|
is complete. Therefore, the peephole definition can check which
|
|
operands have ended up in which kinds of registers, just by looking at
|
|
the operands.
|
|
|
|
@findex prev_active_insn
|
|
The way to refer to the operands in @var{condition} is to write
|
|
@code{operands[@var{i}]} for operand number @var{i} (as matched by
|
|
@code{(match_operand @var{i} @dots{})}). Use the variable @code{insn}
|
|
to refer to the last of the insns being matched; use
|
|
@code{prev_active_insn} to find the preceding insns.
|
|
|
|
@findex dead_or_set_p
|
|
When optimizing computations with intermediate results, you can use
|
|
@var{condition} to match only when the intermediate results are not used
|
|
elsewhere. Use the C expression @code{dead_or_set_p (@var{insn},
|
|
@var{op})}, where @var{insn} is the insn in which you expect the value
|
|
to be used for the last time (from the value of @code{insn}, together
|
|
with use of @code{prev_nonnote_insn}), and @var{op} is the intermediate
|
|
value (from @code{operands[@var{i}]}).
|
|
|
|
Applying the optimization means replacing the sequence of insns with one
|
|
new insn. The @var{template} controls ultimate output of assembler code
|
|
for this combined insn. It works exactly like the template of a
|
|
@code{define_insn}. Operand numbers in this template are the same ones
|
|
used in matching the original sequence of insns.
|
|
|
|
The result of a defined peephole optimizer does not need to match any of
|
|
the insn patterns in the machine description; it does not even have an
|
|
opportunity to match them. The peephole optimizer definition itself serves
|
|
as the insn pattern to control how the insn is output.
|
|
|
|
Defined peephole optimizers are run as assembler code is being output,
|
|
so the insns they produce are never combined or rearranged in any way.
|
|
|
|
Here is an example, taken from the 68000 machine description:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_peephole
|
|
[(set (reg:SI 15) (plus:SI (reg:SI 15) (const_int 4)))
|
|
(set (match_operand:DF 0 "register_operand" "=f")
|
|
(match_operand:DF 1 "register_operand" "ad"))]
|
|
"FP_REG_P (operands[0]) && ! FP_REG_P (operands[1])"
|
|
@{
|
|
rtx xoperands[2];
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1);
|
|
#ifdef MOTOROLA
|
|
output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,(sp)", xoperands);
|
|
output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,-(sp)", operands);
|
|
return "fmove.d (sp)+,%0";
|
|
#else
|
|
output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@", xoperands);
|
|
output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@-", operands);
|
|
return "fmoved sp@@+,%0";
|
|
#endif
|
|
@})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@need 1000
|
|
The effect of this optimization is to change
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
jbsr _foobar
|
|
addql #4,sp
|
|
movel d1,sp@@-
|
|
movel d0,sp@@-
|
|
fmoved sp@@+,fp0
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
into
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
@group
|
|
jbsr _foobar
|
|
movel d1,sp@@
|
|
movel d0,sp@@-
|
|
fmoved sp@@+,fp0
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@ignore
|
|
@findex CC_REVERSED
|
|
If a peephole matches a sequence including one or more jump insns, you must
|
|
take account of the flags such as @code{CC_REVERSED} which specify that the
|
|
condition codes are represented in an unusual manner. The compiler
|
|
automatically alters any ordinary conditional jumps which occur in such
|
|
situations, but the compiler cannot alter jumps which have been replaced by
|
|
peephole optimizations. So it is up to you to alter the assembler code
|
|
that the peephole produces. Supply C code to write the assembler output,
|
|
and in this C code check the condition code status flags and change the
|
|
assembler code as appropriate.
|
|
@end ignore
|
|
|
|
@var{insn-pattern-1} and so on look @emph{almost} like the second
|
|
operand of @code{define_insn}. There is one important difference: the
|
|
second operand of @code{define_insn} consists of one or more RTX's
|
|
enclosed in square brackets. Usually, there is only one: then the same
|
|
action can be written as an element of a @code{define_peephole}. But
|
|
when there are multiple actions in a @code{define_insn}, they are
|
|
implicitly enclosed in a @code{parallel}. Then you must explicitly
|
|
write the @code{parallel}, and the square brackets within it, in the
|
|
@code{define_peephole}. Thus, if an insn pattern looks like this,
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "divmodsi4"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
|
|
(div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
|
|
(mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))]
|
|
"TARGET_68020"
|
|
"divsl%.l %2,%3:%0")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
then the way to mention this insn in a peephole is as follows:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_peephole
|
|
[@dots{}
|
|
(parallel
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
|
|
(div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
|
|
(mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))])
|
|
@dots{}]
|
|
@dots{})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node define_peephole2
|
|
@subsection RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
|
|
@findex define_peephole2
|
|
|
|
The @code{define_peephole2} definition tells the compiler how to
|
|
substitute one sequence of instructions for another sequence,
|
|
what additional scratch registers may be needed and what their
|
|
lifetimes must be.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_peephole2
|
|
[@var{insn-pattern-1}
|
|
@var{insn-pattern-2}
|
|
@dots{}]
|
|
"@var{condition}"
|
|
[@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
|
|
@var{new-insn-pattern-2}
|
|
@dots{}]
|
|
"@var{preparation-statements}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The definition is almost identical to @code{define_split}
|
|
(@pxref{Insn Splitting}) except that the pattern to match is not a
|
|
single instruction, but a sequence of instructions.
|
|
|
|
It is possible to request additional scratch registers for use in the
|
|
output template. If appropriate registers are not free, the pattern
|
|
will simply not match.
|
|
|
|
@findex match_scratch
|
|
@findex match_dup
|
|
Scratch registers are requested with a @code{match_scratch} pattern at
|
|
the top level of the input pattern. The allocated register (initially) will
|
|
be dead at the point requested within the original sequence. If the scratch
|
|
is used at more than a single point, a @code{match_dup} pattern at the
|
|
top level of the input pattern marks the last position in the input sequence
|
|
at which the register must be available.
|
|
|
|
Here is an example from the IA-32 machine description:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_peephole2
|
|
[(match_scratch:SI 2 "r")
|
|
(parallel [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
|
|
(match_operator:SI 3 "arith_or_logical_operator"
|
|
[(match_dup 0)
|
|
(match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")]))
|
|
(clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
|
|
"! optimize_size && ! TARGET_READ_MODIFY"
|
|
[(set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 1))
|
|
(parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
|
|
(match_op_dup 3 [(match_dup 0) (match_dup 2)]))
|
|
(clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
|
|
"")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
This pattern tries to split a load from its use in the hopes that we'll be
|
|
able to schedule around the memory load latency. It allocates a single
|
|
@code{SImode} register of class @code{GENERAL_REGS} (@code{"r"}) that needs
|
|
to be live only at the point just before the arithmetic.
|
|
|
|
A real example requiring extended scratch lifetimes is harder to come by,
|
|
so here's a silly made-up example:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_peephole2
|
|
[(match_scratch:SI 4 "r")
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 0 "" "") (match_operand:SI 1 "" ""))
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 2 "" "") (match_dup 1))
|
|
(match_dup 4)
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 3 "" "") (match_dup 1))]
|
|
"/* @r{determine 1 does not overlap 0 and 2} */"
|
|
[(set (match_dup 4) (match_dup 1))
|
|
(set (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4))
|
|
(set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 4))]
|
|
(set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 4))]
|
|
"")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If we had not added the @code{(match_dup 4)} in the middle of the input
|
|
sequence, it might have been the case that the register we chose at the
|
|
beginning of the sequence is killed by the first or second @code{set}.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Insn Attributes
|
|
@section Instruction Attributes
|
|
@cindex insn attributes
|
|
@cindex instruction attributes
|
|
|
|
In addition to describing the instruction supported by the target machine,
|
|
the @file{md} file also defines a group of @dfn{attributes} and a set of
|
|
values for each. Every generated insn is assigned a value for each attribute.
|
|
One possible attribute would be the effect that the insn has on the machine's
|
|
condition code. This attribute can then be used by @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}
|
|
to track the condition codes.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Defining Attributes:: Specifying attributes and their values.
|
|
* Expressions:: Valid expressions for attribute values.
|
|
* Tagging Insns:: Assigning attribute values to insns.
|
|
* Attr Example:: An example of assigning attributes.
|
|
* Insn Lengths:: Computing the length of insns.
|
|
* Constant Attributes:: Defining attributes that are constant.
|
|
* Delay Slots:: Defining delay slots required for a machine.
|
|
* Processor pipeline description:: Specifying information for insn scheduling.
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Defining Attributes
|
|
@subsection Defining Attributes and their Values
|
|
@cindex defining attributes and their values
|
|
@cindex attributes, defining
|
|
|
|
@findex define_attr
|
|
The @code{define_attr} expression is used to define each attribute required
|
|
by the target machine. It looks like:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_attr @var{name} @var{list-of-values} @var{default})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{name} is a string specifying the name of the attribute being defined.
|
|
|
|
@var{list-of-values} is either a string that specifies a comma-separated
|
|
list of values that can be assigned to the attribute, or a null string to
|
|
indicate that the attribute takes numeric values.
|
|
|
|
@var{default} is an attribute expression that gives the value of this
|
|
attribute for insns that match patterns whose definition does not include
|
|
an explicit value for this attribute. @xref{Attr Example}, for more
|
|
information on the handling of defaults. @xref{Constant Attributes},
|
|
for information on attributes that do not depend on any particular insn.
|
|
|
|
@findex insn-attr.h
|
|
For each defined attribute, a number of definitions are written to the
|
|
@file{insn-attr.h} file. For cases where an explicit set of values is
|
|
specified for an attribute, the following are defined:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
A @samp{#define} is written for the symbol @samp{HAVE_ATTR_@var{name}}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
An enumerated class is defined for @samp{attr_@var{name}} with
|
|
elements of the form @samp{@var{upper-name}_@var{upper-value}} where
|
|
the attribute name and value are first converted to uppercase.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
A function @samp{get_attr_@var{name}} is defined that is passed an insn and
|
|
returns the attribute value for that insn.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, if the following is present in the @file{md} file:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_attr "type" "branch,fp,load,store,arith" @dots{})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
the following lines will be written to the file @file{insn-attr.h}.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
#define HAVE_ATTR_type
|
|
enum attr_type @{TYPE_BRANCH, TYPE_FP, TYPE_LOAD,
|
|
TYPE_STORE, TYPE_ARITH@};
|
|
extern enum attr_type get_attr_type ();
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
If the attribute takes numeric values, no @code{enum} type will be
|
|
defined and the function to obtain the attribute's value will return
|
|
@code{int}.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Expressions
|
|
@subsection Attribute Expressions
|
|
@cindex attribute expressions
|
|
|
|
RTL expressions used to define attributes use the codes described above
|
|
plus a few specific to attribute definitions, to be discussed below.
|
|
Attribute value expressions must have one of the following forms:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@cindex @code{const_int} and attributes
|
|
@item (const_int @var{i})
|
|
The integer @var{i} specifies the value of a numeric attribute. @var{i}
|
|
must be non-negative.
|
|
|
|
The value of a numeric attribute can be specified either with a
|
|
@code{const_int}, or as an integer represented as a string in
|
|
@code{const_string}, @code{eq_attr} (see below), @code{attr},
|
|
@code{symbol_ref}, simple arithmetic expressions, and @code{set_attr}
|
|
overrides on specific instructions (@pxref{Tagging Insns}).
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{const_string} and attributes
|
|
@item (const_string @var{value})
|
|
The string @var{value} specifies a constant attribute value.
|
|
If @var{value} is specified as @samp{"*"}, it means that the default value of
|
|
the attribute is to be used for the insn containing this expression.
|
|
@samp{"*"} obviously cannot be used in the @var{default} expression
|
|
of a @code{define_attr}.
|
|
|
|
If the attribute whose value is being specified is numeric, @var{value}
|
|
must be a string containing a non-negative integer (normally
|
|
@code{const_int} would be used in this case). Otherwise, it must
|
|
contain one of the valid values for the attribute.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{if_then_else} and attributes
|
|
@item (if_then_else @var{test} @var{true-value} @var{false-value})
|
|
@var{test} specifies an attribute test, whose format is defined below.
|
|
The value of this expression is @var{true-value} if @var{test} is true,
|
|
otherwise it is @var{false-value}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{cond} and attributes
|
|
@item (cond [@var{test1} @var{value1} @dots{}] @var{default})
|
|
The first operand of this expression is a vector containing an even
|
|
number of expressions and consisting of pairs of @var{test} and @var{value}
|
|
expressions. The value of the @code{cond} expression is that of the
|
|
@var{value} corresponding to the first true @var{test} expression. If
|
|
none of the @var{test} expressions are true, the value of the @code{cond}
|
|
expression is that of the @var{default} expression.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@var{test} expressions can have one of the following forms:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@cindex @code{const_int} and attribute tests
|
|
@item (const_int @var{i})
|
|
This test is true if @var{i} is nonzero and false otherwise.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{not} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{ior} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{and} and attributes
|
|
@item (not @var{test})
|
|
@itemx (ior @var{test1} @var{test2})
|
|
@itemx (and @var{test1} @var{test2})
|
|
These tests are true if the indicated logical function is true.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{match_operand} and attributes
|
|
@item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{pred} @var{constraints})
|
|
This test is true if operand @var{n} of the insn whose attribute value
|
|
is being determined has mode @var{m} (this part of the test is ignored
|
|
if @var{m} is @code{VOIDmode}) and the function specified by the string
|
|
@var{pred} returns a nonzero value when passed operand @var{n} and mode
|
|
@var{m} (this part of the test is ignored if @var{pred} is the null
|
|
string).
|
|
|
|
The @var{constraints} operand is ignored and should be the null string.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{le} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{leu} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{lt} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{gt} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{gtu} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{ge} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{geu} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{ne} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{eq} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{plus} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{minus} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{mult} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{div} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{mod} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{abs} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{neg} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{ashift} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{lshiftrt} and attributes
|
|
@cindex @code{ashiftrt} and attributes
|
|
@item (le @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (leu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (lt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (ltu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (gt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (gtu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (ge @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (geu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (ne @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
@itemx (eq @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
|
|
These tests are true if the indicated comparison of the two arithmetic
|
|
expressions is true. Arithmetic expressions are formed with
|
|
@code{plus}, @code{minus}, @code{mult}, @code{div}, @code{mod},
|
|
@code{abs}, @code{neg}, @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor}, @code{not},
|
|
@code{ashift}, @code{lshiftrt}, and @code{ashiftrt} expressions.
|
|
|
|
@findex get_attr
|
|
@code{const_int} and @code{symbol_ref} are always valid terms (@pxref{Insn
|
|
Lengths},for additional forms). @code{symbol_ref} is a string
|
|
denoting a C expression that yields an @code{int} when evaluated by the
|
|
@samp{get_attr_@dots{}} routine. It should normally be a global
|
|
variable.
|
|
|
|
@findex eq_attr
|
|
@item (eq_attr @var{name} @var{value})
|
|
@var{name} is a string specifying the name of an attribute.
|
|
|
|
@var{value} is a string that is either a valid value for attribute
|
|
@var{name}, a comma-separated list of values, or @samp{!} followed by a
|
|
value or list. If @var{value} does not begin with a @samp{!}, this
|
|
test is true if the value of the @var{name} attribute of the current
|
|
insn is in the list specified by @var{value}. If @var{value} begins
|
|
with a @samp{!}, this test is true if the attribute's value is
|
|
@emph{not} in the specified list.
|
|
|
|
For example,
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(eq_attr "type" "load,store")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(ior (eq_attr "type" "load") (eq_attr "type" "store"))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
If @var{name} specifies an attribute of @samp{alternative}, it refers to the
|
|
value of the compiler variable @code{which_alternative}
|
|
(@pxref{Output Statement}) and the values must be small integers. For
|
|
example,
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(eq_attr "alternative" "2,3")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(ior (eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 2))
|
|
(eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 3)))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Note that, for most attributes, an @code{eq_attr} test is simplified in cases
|
|
where the value of the attribute being tested is known for all insns matching
|
|
a particular pattern. This is by far the most common case.
|
|
|
|
@findex attr_flag
|
|
@item (attr_flag @var{name})
|
|
The value of an @code{attr_flag} expression is true if the flag
|
|
specified by @var{name} is true for the @code{insn} currently being
|
|
scheduled.
|
|
|
|
@var{name} is a string specifying one of a fixed set of flags to test.
|
|
Test the flags @code{forward} and @code{backward} to determine the
|
|
direction of a conditional branch. Test the flags @code{very_likely},
|
|
@code{likely}, @code{very_unlikely}, and @code{unlikely} to determine
|
|
if a conditional branch is expected to be taken.
|
|
|
|
If the @code{very_likely} flag is true, then the @code{likely} flag is also
|
|
true. Likewise for the @code{very_unlikely} and @code{unlikely} flags.
|
|
|
|
This example describes a conditional branch delay slot which
|
|
can be nullified for forward branches that are taken (annul-true) or
|
|
for backward branches which are not taken (annul-false).
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "cbranch")
|
|
[(eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
|
|
(and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
|
|
(attr_flag "forward"))
|
|
(and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
|
|
(attr_flag "backward"))])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The @code{forward} and @code{backward} flags are false if the current
|
|
@code{insn} being scheduled is not a conditional branch.
|
|
|
|
The @code{very_likely} and @code{likely} flags are true if the
|
|
@code{insn} being scheduled is not a conditional branch.
|
|
The @code{very_unlikely} and @code{unlikely} flags are false if the
|
|
@code{insn} being scheduled is not a conditional branch.
|
|
|
|
@code{attr_flag} is only used during delay slot scheduling and has no
|
|
meaning to other passes of the compiler.
|
|
|
|
@findex attr
|
|
@item (attr @var{name})
|
|
The value of another attribute is returned. This is most useful
|
|
for numeric attributes, as @code{eq_attr} and @code{attr_flag}
|
|
produce more efficient code for non-numeric attributes.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Tagging Insns
|
|
@subsection Assigning Attribute Values to Insns
|
|
@cindex tagging insns
|
|
@cindex assigning attribute values to insns
|
|
|
|
The value assigned to an attribute of an insn is primarily determined by
|
|
which pattern is matched by that insn (or which @code{define_peephole}
|
|
generated it). Every @code{define_insn} and @code{define_peephole} can
|
|
have an optional last argument to specify the values of attributes for
|
|
matching insns. The value of any attribute not specified in a particular
|
|
insn is set to the default value for that attribute, as specified in its
|
|
@code{define_attr}. Extensive use of default values for attributes
|
|
permits the specification of the values for only one or two attributes
|
|
in the definition of most insn patterns, as seen in the example in the
|
|
next section.
|
|
|
|
The optional last argument of @code{define_insn} and
|
|
@code{define_peephole} is a vector of expressions, each of which defines
|
|
the value for a single attribute. The most general way of assigning an
|
|
attribute's value is to use a @code{set} expression whose first operand is an
|
|
@code{attr} expression giving the name of the attribute being set. The
|
|
second operand of the @code{set} is an attribute expression
|
|
(@pxref{Expressions}) giving the value of the attribute.
|
|
|
|
When the attribute value depends on the @samp{alternative} attribute
|
|
(i.e., which is the applicable alternative in the constraint of the
|
|
insn), the @code{set_attr_alternative} expression can be used. It
|
|
allows the specification of a vector of attribute expressions, one for
|
|
each alternative.
|
|
|
|
@findex set_attr
|
|
When the generality of arbitrary attribute expressions is not required,
|
|
the simpler @code{set_attr} expression can be used, which allows
|
|
specifying a string giving either a single attribute value or a list
|
|
of attribute values, one for each alternative.
|
|
|
|
The form of each of the above specifications is shown below. In each case,
|
|
@var{name} is a string specifying the attribute to be set.
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item (set_attr @var{name} @var{value-string})
|
|
@var{value-string} is either a string giving the desired attribute value,
|
|
or a string containing a comma-separated list giving the values for
|
|
succeeding alternatives. The number of elements must match the number
|
|
of alternatives in the constraint of the insn pattern.
|
|
|
|
Note that it may be useful to specify @samp{*} for some alternative, in
|
|
which case the attribute will assume its default value for insns matching
|
|
that alternative.
|
|
|
|
@findex set_attr_alternative
|
|
@item (set_attr_alternative @var{name} [@var{value1} @var{value2} @dots{}])
|
|
Depending on the alternative of the insn, the value will be one of the
|
|
specified values. This is a shorthand for using a @code{cond} with
|
|
tests on the @samp{alternative} attribute.
|
|
|
|
@findex attr
|
|
@item (set (attr @var{name}) @var{value})
|
|
The first operand of this @code{set} must be the special RTL expression
|
|
@code{attr}, whose sole operand is a string giving the name of the
|
|
attribute being set. @var{value} is the value of the attribute.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
The following shows three different ways of representing the same
|
|
attribute value specification:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(set_attr "type" "load,store,arith")
|
|
|
|
(set_attr_alternative "type"
|
|
[(const_string "load") (const_string "store")
|
|
(const_string "arith")])
|
|
|
|
(set (attr "type")
|
|
(cond [(eq_attr "alternative" "1") (const_string "load")
|
|
(eq_attr "alternative" "2") (const_string "store")]
|
|
(const_string "arith")))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@need 1000
|
|
@findex define_asm_attributes
|
|
The @code{define_asm_attributes} expression provides a mechanism to
|
|
specify the attributes assigned to insns produced from an @code{asm}
|
|
statement. It has the form:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_asm_attributes [@var{attr-sets}])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
where @var{attr-sets} is specified the same as for both the
|
|
@code{define_insn} and the @code{define_peephole} expressions.
|
|
|
|
These values will typically be the ``worst case'' attribute values. For
|
|
example, they might indicate that the condition code will be clobbered.
|
|
|
|
A specification for a @code{length} attribute is handled specially. The
|
|
way to compute the length of an @code{asm} insn is to multiply the
|
|
length specified in the expression @code{define_asm_attributes} by the
|
|
number of machine instructions specified in the @code{asm} statement,
|
|
determined by counting the number of semicolons and newlines in the
|
|
string. Therefore, the value of the @code{length} attribute specified
|
|
in a @code{define_asm_attributes} should be the maximum possible length
|
|
of a single machine instruction.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Attr Example
|
|
@subsection Example of Attribute Specifications
|
|
@cindex attribute specifications example
|
|
@cindex attribute specifications
|
|
|
|
The judicious use of defaulting is important in the efficient use of
|
|
insn attributes. Typically, insns are divided into @dfn{types} and an
|
|
attribute, customarily called @code{type}, is used to represent this
|
|
value. This attribute is normally used only to define the default value
|
|
for other attributes. An example will clarify this usage.
|
|
|
|
Assume we have a RISC machine with a condition code and in which only
|
|
full-word operations are performed in registers. Let us assume that we
|
|
can divide all insns into loads, stores, (integer) arithmetic
|
|
operations, floating point operations, and branches.
|
|
|
|
Here we will concern ourselves with determining the effect of an insn on
|
|
the condition code and will limit ourselves to the following possible
|
|
effects: The condition code can be set unpredictably (clobbered), not
|
|
be changed, be set to agree with the results of the operation, or only
|
|
changed if the item previously set into the condition code has been
|
|
modified.
|
|
|
|
Here is part of a sample @file{md} file for such a machine:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_attr "type" "load,store,arith,fp,branch" (const_string "arith"))
|
|
|
|
(define_attr "cc" "clobber,unchanged,set,change0"
|
|
(cond [(eq_attr "type" "load")
|
|
(const_string "change0")
|
|
(eq_attr "type" "store,branch")
|
|
(const_string "unchanged")
|
|
(eq_attr "type" "arith")
|
|
(if_then_else (match_operand:SI 0 "" "")
|
|
(const_string "set")
|
|
(const_string "clobber"))]
|
|
(const_string "clobber")))
|
|
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,r,m")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r,m,r"))]
|
|
""
|
|
"@@
|
|
move %0,%1
|
|
load %0,%1
|
|
store %0,%1"
|
|
[(set_attr "type" "arith,load,store")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Note that we assume in the above example that arithmetic operations
|
|
performed on quantities smaller than a machine word clobber the condition
|
|
code since they will set the condition code to a value corresponding to the
|
|
full-word result.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Insn Lengths
|
|
@subsection Computing the Length of an Insn
|
|
@cindex insn lengths, computing
|
|
@cindex computing the length of an insn
|
|
|
|
For many machines, multiple types of branch instructions are provided, each
|
|
for different length branch displacements. In most cases, the assembler
|
|
will choose the correct instruction to use. However, when the assembler
|
|
cannot do so, GCC can when a special attribute, the @code{length}
|
|
attribute, is defined. This attribute must be defined to have numeric
|
|
values by specifying a null string in its @code{define_attr}.
|
|
|
|
In the case of the @code{length} attribute, two additional forms of
|
|
arithmetic terms are allowed in test expressions:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@cindex @code{match_dup} and attributes
|
|
@item (match_dup @var{n})
|
|
This refers to the address of operand @var{n} of the current insn, which
|
|
must be a @code{label_ref}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{pc} and attributes
|
|
@item (pc)
|
|
This refers to the address of the @emph{current} insn. It might have
|
|
been more consistent with other usage to make this the address of the
|
|
@emph{next} insn but this would be confusing because the length of the
|
|
current insn is to be computed.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{addr_vec}, length of
|
|
@cindex @code{addr_diff_vec}, length of
|
|
For normal insns, the length will be determined by value of the
|
|
@code{length} attribute. In the case of @code{addr_vec} and
|
|
@code{addr_diff_vec} insn patterns, the length is computed as
|
|
the number of vectors multiplied by the size of each vector.
|
|
|
|
Lengths are measured in addressable storage units (bytes).
|
|
|
|
The following macros can be used to refine the length computation:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@findex ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH
|
|
@item ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH (@var{insn}, @var{length})
|
|
If defined, modifies the length assigned to instruction @var{insn} as a
|
|
function of the context in which it is used. @var{length} is an lvalue
|
|
that contains the initially computed length of the insn and should be
|
|
updated with the correct length of the insn.
|
|
|
|
This macro will normally not be required. A case in which it is
|
|
required is the ROMP@. On this machine, the size of an @code{addr_vec}
|
|
insn must be increased by two to compensate for the fact that alignment
|
|
may be required.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@findex get_attr_length
|
|
The routine that returns @code{get_attr_length} (the value of the
|
|
@code{length} attribute) can be used by the output routine to
|
|
determine the form of the branch instruction to be written, as the
|
|
example below illustrates.
|
|
|
|
As an example of the specification of variable-length branches, consider
|
|
the IBM 360. If we adopt the convention that a register will be set to
|
|
the starting address of a function, we can jump to labels within 4k of
|
|
the start using a four-byte instruction. Otherwise, we need a six-byte
|
|
sequence to load the address from memory and then branch to it.
|
|
|
|
On such a machine, a pattern for a branch instruction might be specified
|
|
as follows:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "jump"
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 0 "" "")))]
|
|
""
|
|
@{
|
|
return (get_attr_length (insn) == 4
|
|
? "b %l0" : "l r15,=a(%l0); br r15");
|
|
@}
|
|
[(set (attr "length")
|
|
(if_then_else (lt (match_dup 0) (const_int 4096))
|
|
(const_int 4)
|
|
(const_int 6)))])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Constant Attributes
|
|
@subsection Constant Attributes
|
|
@cindex constant attributes
|
|
|
|
A special form of @code{define_attr}, where the expression for the
|
|
default value is a @code{const} expression, indicates an attribute that
|
|
is constant for a given run of the compiler. Constant attributes may be
|
|
used to specify which variety of processor is used. For example,
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_attr "cpu" "m88100,m88110,m88000"
|
|
(const
|
|
(cond [(symbol_ref "TARGET_88100") (const_string "m88100")
|
|
(symbol_ref "TARGET_88110") (const_string "m88110")]
|
|
(const_string "m88000"))))
|
|
|
|
(define_attr "memory" "fast,slow"
|
|
(const
|
|
(if_then_else (symbol_ref "TARGET_FAST_MEM")
|
|
(const_string "fast")
|
|
(const_string "slow"))))
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The routine generated for constant attributes has no parameters as it
|
|
does not depend on any particular insn. RTL expressions used to define
|
|
the value of a constant attribute may use the @code{symbol_ref} form,
|
|
but may not use either the @code{match_operand} form or @code{eq_attr}
|
|
forms involving insn attributes.
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Delay Slots
|
|
@subsection Delay Slot Scheduling
|
|
@cindex delay slots, defining
|
|
|
|
The insn attribute mechanism can be used to specify the requirements for
|
|
delay slots, if any, on a target machine. An instruction is said to
|
|
require a @dfn{delay slot} if some instructions that are physically
|
|
after the instruction are executed as if they were located before it.
|
|
Classic examples are branch and call instructions, which often execute
|
|
the following instruction before the branch or call is performed.
|
|
|
|
On some machines, conditional branch instructions can optionally
|
|
@dfn{annul} instructions in the delay slot. This means that the
|
|
instruction will not be executed for certain branch outcomes. Both
|
|
instructions that annul if the branch is true and instructions that
|
|
annul if the branch is false are supported.
|
|
|
|
Delay slot scheduling differs from instruction scheduling in that
|
|
determining whether an instruction needs a delay slot is dependent only
|
|
on the type of instruction being generated, not on data flow between the
|
|
instructions. See the next section for a discussion of data-dependent
|
|
instruction scheduling.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_delay
|
|
The requirement of an insn needing one or more delay slots is indicated
|
|
via the @code{define_delay} expression. It has the following form:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_delay @var{test}
|
|
[@var{delay-1} @var{annul-true-1} @var{annul-false-1}
|
|
@var{delay-2} @var{annul-true-2} @var{annul-false-2}
|
|
@dots{}])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{test} is an attribute test that indicates whether this
|
|
@code{define_delay} applies to a particular insn. If so, the number of
|
|
required delay slots is determined by the length of the vector specified
|
|
as the second argument. An insn placed in delay slot @var{n} must
|
|
satisfy attribute test @var{delay-n}. @var{annul-true-n} is an
|
|
attribute test that specifies which insns may be annulled if the branch
|
|
is true. Similarly, @var{annul-false-n} specifies which insns in the
|
|
delay slot may be annulled if the branch is false. If annulling is not
|
|
supported for that delay slot, @code{(nil)} should be coded.
|
|
|
|
For example, in the common case where branch and call insns require
|
|
a single delay slot, which may contain any insn other than a branch or
|
|
call, the following would be placed in the @file{md} file:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch,call")
|
|
[(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Multiple @code{define_delay} expressions may be specified. In this
|
|
case, each such expression specifies different delay slot requirements
|
|
and there must be no insn for which tests in two @code{define_delay}
|
|
expressions are both true.
|
|
|
|
For example, if we have a machine that requires one delay slot for branches
|
|
but two for calls, no delay slot can contain a branch or call insn,
|
|
and any valid insn in the delay slot for the branch can be annulled if the
|
|
branch is true, we might represent this as follows:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch")
|
|
[(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
|
|
(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
|
|
(nil)])
|
|
|
|
(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "call")
|
|
[(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)
|
|
(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
@c the above is *still* too long. --mew 4feb93
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Processor pipeline description
|
|
@subsection Specifying processor pipeline description
|
|
@cindex processor pipeline description
|
|
@cindex processor functional units
|
|
@cindex instruction latency time
|
|
@cindex interlock delays
|
|
@cindex data dependence delays
|
|
@cindex reservation delays
|
|
@cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
|
|
@cindex automaton based pipeline description
|
|
@cindex regular expressions
|
|
@cindex deterministic finite state automaton
|
|
@cindex automaton based scheduler
|
|
@cindex RISC
|
|
@cindex VLIW
|
|
|
|
To achieve better performance, most modern processors
|
|
(super-pipelined, superscalar @acronym{RISC}, and @acronym{VLIW}
|
|
processors) have many @dfn{functional units} on which several
|
|
instructions can be executed simultaneously. An instruction starts
|
|
execution if its issue conditions are satisfied. If not, the
|
|
instruction is stalled until its conditions are satisfied. Such
|
|
@dfn{interlock (pipeline) delay} causes interruption of the fetching
|
|
of successor instructions (or demands nop instructions, e.g.@: for some
|
|
MIPS processors).
|
|
|
|
There are two major kinds of interlock delays in modern processors.
|
|
The first one is a data dependence delay determining @dfn{instruction
|
|
latency time}. The instruction execution is not started until all
|
|
source data have been evaluated by prior instructions (there are more
|
|
complex cases when the instruction execution starts even when the data
|
|
are not available but will be ready in given time after the
|
|
instruction execution start). Taking the data dependence delays into
|
|
account is simple. The data dependence (true, output, and
|
|
anti-dependence) delay between two instructions is given by a
|
|
constant. In most cases this approach is adequate. The second kind
|
|
of interlock delays is a reservation delay. The reservation delay
|
|
means that two instructions under execution will be in need of shared
|
|
processors resources, i.e.@: buses, internal registers, and/or
|
|
functional units, which are reserved for some time. Taking this kind
|
|
of delay into account is complex especially for modern @acronym{RISC}
|
|
processors.
|
|
|
|
The task of exploiting more processor parallelism is solved by an
|
|
instruction scheduler. For a better solution to this problem, the
|
|
instruction scheduler has to have an adequate description of the
|
|
processor parallelism (or @dfn{pipeline description}). GCC
|
|
machine descriptions describe processor parallelism and functional
|
|
unit reservations for groups of instructions with the aid of
|
|
@dfn{regular expressions}.
|
|
|
|
The GCC instruction scheduler uses a @dfn{pipeline hazard recognizer} to
|
|
figure out the possibility of the instruction issue by the processor
|
|
on a given simulated processor cycle. The pipeline hazard recognizer is
|
|
automatically generated from the processor pipeline description. The
|
|
pipeline hazard recognizer generated from the machine description
|
|
is based on a deterministic finite state automaton (@acronym{DFA}):
|
|
the instruction issue is possible if there is a transition from one
|
|
automaton state to another one. This algorithm is very fast, and
|
|
furthermore, its speed is not dependent on processor
|
|
complexity@footnote{However, the size of the automaton depends on
|
|
processor complexity. To limit this effect, machine descriptions
|
|
can split orthogonal parts of the machine description among several
|
|
automata: but then, since each of these must be stepped independently,
|
|
this does cause a small decrease in the algorithm's performance.}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex automaton based pipeline description
|
|
The rest of this section describes the directives that constitute
|
|
an automaton-based processor pipeline description. The order of
|
|
these constructions within the machine description file is not
|
|
important.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_automaton
|
|
@cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
|
|
The following optional construction describes names of automata
|
|
generated and used for the pipeline hazards recognition. Sometimes
|
|
the generated finite state automaton used by the pipeline hazard
|
|
recognizer is large. If we use more than one automaton and bind functional
|
|
units to the automata, the total size of the automata is usually
|
|
less than the size of the single automaton. If there is no one such
|
|
construction, only one finite state automaton is generated.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_automaton @var{automata-names})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{automata-names} is a string giving names of the automata. The
|
|
names are separated by commas. All the automata should have unique names.
|
|
The automaton name is used in the constructions @code{define_cpu_unit} and
|
|
@code{define_query_cpu_unit}.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_cpu_unit
|
|
@cindex processor functional units
|
|
Each processor functional unit used in the description of instruction
|
|
reservations should be described by the following construction.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{unit-names} is a string giving the names of the functional units
|
|
separated by commas. Don't use name @samp{nothing}, it is reserved
|
|
for other goals.
|
|
|
|
@var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
|
|
which the unit is bound. The automaton should be described in
|
|
construction @code{define_automaton}. You should give
|
|
@dfn{automaton-name}, if there is a defined automaton.
|
|
|
|
The assignment of units to automata are constrained by the uses of the
|
|
units in insn reservations. The most important constraint is: if a
|
|
unit reservation is present on a particular cycle of an alternative
|
|
for an insn reservation, then some unit from the same automaton must
|
|
be present on the same cycle for the other alternatives of the insn
|
|
reservation. The rest of the constraints are mentioned in the
|
|
description of the subsequent constructions.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_query_cpu_unit
|
|
@cindex querying function unit reservations
|
|
The following construction describes CPU functional units analogously
|
|
to @code{define_cpu_unit}. The reservation of such units can be
|
|
queried for an automaton state. The instruction scheduler never
|
|
queries reservation of functional units for given automaton state. So
|
|
as a rule, you don't need this construction. This construction could
|
|
be used for future code generation goals (e.g.@: to generate
|
|
@acronym{VLIW} insn templates).
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_query_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{unit-names} is a string giving names of the functional units
|
|
separated by commas.
|
|
|
|
@var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
|
|
which the unit is bound.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_insn_reservation
|
|
@cindex instruction latency time
|
|
@cindex regular expressions
|
|
@cindex data bypass
|
|
The following construction is the major one to describe pipeline
|
|
characteristics of an instruction.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn_reservation @var{insn-name} @var{default_latency}
|
|
@var{condition} @var{regexp})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{default_latency} is a number giving latency time of the
|
|
instruction. There is an important difference between the old
|
|
description and the automaton based pipeline description. The latency
|
|
time is used for all dependencies when we use the old description. In
|
|
the automaton based pipeline description, the given latency time is only
|
|
used for true dependencies. The cost of anti-dependencies is always
|
|
zero and the cost of output dependencies is the difference between
|
|
latency times of the producing and consuming insns (if the difference
|
|
is negative, the cost is considered to be zero). You can always
|
|
change the default costs for any description by using the target hook
|
|
@code{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST} (@pxref{Scheduling}).
|
|
|
|
@var{insn-name} is a string giving the internal name of the insn. The
|
|
internal names are used in constructions @code{define_bypass} and in
|
|
the automaton description file generated for debugging. The internal
|
|
name has nothing in common with the names in @code{define_insn}. It is a
|
|
good practice to use insn classes described in the processor manual.
|
|
|
|
@var{condition} defines what RTL insns are described by this
|
|
construction. You should remember that you will be in trouble if
|
|
@var{condition} for two or more different
|
|
@code{define_insn_reservation} constructions is TRUE for an insn. In
|
|
this case what reservation will be used for the insn is not defined.
|
|
Such cases are not checked during generation of the pipeline hazards
|
|
recognizer because in general recognizing that two conditions may have
|
|
the same value is quite difficult (especially if the conditions
|
|
contain @code{symbol_ref}). It is also not checked during the
|
|
pipeline hazard recognizer work because it would slow down the
|
|
recognizer considerably.
|
|
|
|
@var{regexp} is a string describing the reservation of the cpu's functional
|
|
units by the instruction. The reservations are described by a regular
|
|
expression according to the following syntax:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
regexp = regexp "," oneof
|
|
| oneof
|
|
|
|
oneof = oneof "|" allof
|
|
| allof
|
|
|
|
allof = allof "+" repeat
|
|
| repeat
|
|
|
|
repeat = element "*" number
|
|
| element
|
|
|
|
element = cpu_function_unit_name
|
|
| reservation_name
|
|
| result_name
|
|
| "nothing"
|
|
| "(" regexp ")"
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{,} is used for describing the start of the next cycle in
|
|
the reservation.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{|} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
|
|
regular expression @strong{or} a reservation described by the second
|
|
regular expression @strong{or} etc.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{+} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
|
|
regular expression @strong{and} a reservation described by the
|
|
second regular expression @strong{and} etc.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{*} is used for convenience and simply means a sequence in which
|
|
the regular expression are repeated @var{number} times with cycle
|
|
advancing (see @samp{,}).
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{cpu_function_unit_name} denotes reservation of the named
|
|
functional unit.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{reservation_name} --- see description of construction
|
|
@samp{define_reservation}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@samp{nothing} denotes no unit reservations.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@findex define_reservation
|
|
Sometimes unit reservations for different insns contain common parts.
|
|
In such case, you can simplify the pipeline description by describing
|
|
the common part by the following construction
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_reservation @var{reservation-name} @var{regexp})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{reservation-name} is a string giving name of @var{regexp}.
|
|
Functional unit names and reservation names are in the same name
|
|
space. So the reservation names should be different from the
|
|
functional unit names and can not be the reserved name @samp{nothing}.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_bypass
|
|
@cindex instruction latency time
|
|
@cindex data bypass
|
|
The following construction is used to describe exceptions in the
|
|
latency time for given instruction pair. This is so called bypasses.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_bypass @var{number} @var{out_insn_names} @var{in_insn_names}
|
|
[@var{guard}])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{number} defines when the result generated by the instructions
|
|
given in string @var{out_insn_names} will be ready for the
|
|
instructions given in string @var{in_insn_names}. The instructions in
|
|
the string are separated by commas.
|
|
|
|
@var{guard} is an optional string giving the name of a C function which
|
|
defines an additional guard for the bypass. The function will get the
|
|
two insns as parameters. If the function returns zero the bypass will
|
|
be ignored for this case. The additional guard is necessary to
|
|
recognize complicated bypasses, e.g.@: when the consumer is only an address
|
|
of insn @samp{store} (not a stored value).
|
|
|
|
@findex exclusion_set
|
|
@findex presence_set
|
|
@findex final_presence_set
|
|
@findex absence_set
|
|
@findex final_absence_set
|
|
@cindex VLIW
|
|
@cindex RISC
|
|
The following five constructions are usually used to describe
|
|
@acronym{VLIW} processors, or more precisely, to describe a placement
|
|
of small instructions into @acronym{VLIW} instruction slots. They
|
|
can be used for @acronym{RISC} processors, too.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(exclusion_set @var{unit-names} @var{unit-names})
|
|
(presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
|
|
(final_presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
|
|
(absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
|
|
(final_absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{unit-names} is a string giving names of functional units
|
|
separated by commas.
|
|
|
|
@var{patterns} is a string giving patterns of functional units
|
|
separated by comma. Currently pattern is one unit or units
|
|
separated by white-spaces.
|
|
|
|
The first construction (@samp{exclusion_set}) means that each
|
|
functional unit in the first string can not be reserved simultaneously
|
|
with a unit whose name is in the second string and vice versa. For
|
|
example, the construction is useful for describing processors
|
|
(e.g.@: some SPARC processors) with a fully pipelined floating point
|
|
functional unit which can execute simultaneously only single floating
|
|
point insns or only double floating point insns.
|
|
|
|
The second construction (@samp{presence_set}) means that each
|
|
functional unit in the first string can not be reserved unless at
|
|
least one of pattern of units whose names are in the second string is
|
|
reserved. This is an asymmetric relation. For example, it is useful
|
|
for description that @acronym{VLIW} @samp{slot1} is reserved after
|
|
@samp{slot0} reservation. We could describe it by the following
|
|
construction
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Or @samp{slot1} is reserved only after @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
|
|
reservation. In this case we could write
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(presence_set "slot1" "slot0 b0")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The third construction (@samp{final_presence_set}) is analogous to
|
|
@samp{presence_set}. The difference between them is when checking is
|
|
done. When an instruction is issued in given automaton state
|
|
reflecting all current and planned unit reservations, the automaton
|
|
state is changed. The first state is a source state, the second one
|
|
is a result state. Checking for @samp{presence_set} is done on the
|
|
source state reservation, checking for @samp{final_presence_set} is
|
|
done on the result reservation. This construction is useful to
|
|
describe a reservation which is actually two subsequent reservations.
|
|
For example, if we use
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
the following insn will be never issued (because @samp{slot1} requires
|
|
@samp{slot0} which is absent in the source state).
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_reservation "insn_and_nop" "slot0 + slot1")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
but it can be issued if we use analogous @samp{final_presence_set}.
|
|
|
|
The forth construction (@samp{absence_set}) means that each functional
|
|
unit in the first string can be reserved only if each pattern of units
|
|
whose names are in the second string is not reserved. This is an
|
|
asymmetric relation (actually @samp{exclusion_set} is analogous to
|
|
this one but it is symmetric). For example it might be useful in a
|
|
@acronym{VLIW} description to say that @samp{slot0} cannot be reserved
|
|
after either @samp{slot1} or @samp{slot2} have been reserved. This
|
|
can be described as:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(absence_set "slot0" "slot1, slot2")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Or @samp{slot2} can not be reserved if @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
|
|
are reserved or @samp{slot1} and unit @samp{b1} are reserved. In
|
|
this case we could write
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(absence_set "slot2" "slot0 b0, slot1 b1")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
All functional units mentioned in a set should belong to the same
|
|
automaton.
|
|
|
|
The last construction (@samp{final_absence_set}) is analogous to
|
|
@samp{absence_set} but checking is done on the result (state)
|
|
reservation. See comments for @samp{final_presence_set}.
|
|
|
|
@findex automata_option
|
|
@cindex deterministic finite state automaton
|
|
@cindex nondeterministic finite state automaton
|
|
@cindex finite state automaton minimization
|
|
You can control the generator of the pipeline hazard recognizer with
|
|
the following construction.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(automata_option @var{options})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{options} is a string giving options which affect the generated
|
|
code. Currently there are the following options:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
@dfn{no-minimization} makes no minimization of the automaton. This is
|
|
only worth to do when we are debugging the description and need to
|
|
look more accurately at reservations of states.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@dfn{time} means printing additional time statistics about
|
|
generation of automata.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@dfn{v} means a generation of the file describing the result automata.
|
|
The file has suffix @samp{.dfa} and can be used for the description
|
|
verification and debugging.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@dfn{w} means a generation of warning instead of error for
|
|
non-critical errors.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@dfn{ndfa} makes nondeterministic finite state automata. This affects
|
|
the treatment of operator @samp{|} in the regular expressions. The
|
|
usual treatment of the operator is to try the first alternative and,
|
|
if the reservation is not possible, the second alternative. The
|
|
nondeterministic treatment means trying all alternatives, some of them
|
|
may be rejected by reservations in the subsequent insns.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@dfn{progress} means output of a progress bar showing how many states
|
|
were generated so far for automaton being processed. This is useful
|
|
during debugging a @acronym{DFA} description. If you see too many
|
|
generated states, you could interrupt the generator of the pipeline
|
|
hazard recognizer and try to figure out a reason for generation of the
|
|
huge automaton.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
As an example, consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} machine which can
|
|
issue three insns (two integer insns and one floating point insn) on
|
|
the cycle but can finish only two insns. To describe this, we define
|
|
the following functional units.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_cpu_unit "i0_pipeline, i1_pipeline, f_pipeline")
|
|
(define_cpu_unit "port0, port1")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
All simple integer insns can be executed in any integer pipeline and
|
|
their result is ready in two cycles. The simple integer insns are
|
|
issued into the first pipeline unless it is reserved, otherwise they
|
|
are issued into the second pipeline. Integer division and
|
|
multiplication insns can be executed only in the second integer
|
|
pipeline and their results are ready correspondingly in 8 and 4
|
|
cycles. The integer division is not pipelined, i.e.@: the subsequent
|
|
integer division insn can not be issued until the current division
|
|
insn finished. Floating point insns are fully pipelined and their
|
|
results are ready in 3 cycles. Where the result of a floating point
|
|
insn is used by an integer insn, an additional delay of one cycle is
|
|
incurred. To describe all of this we could specify
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_cpu_unit "div")
|
|
|
|
(define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
|
|
"(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), (port0 | port1)")
|
|
|
|
(define_insn_reservation "mult" 4 (eq_attr "type" "mult")
|
|
"i1_pipeline, nothing*2, (port0 | port1)")
|
|
|
|
(define_insn_reservation "div" 8 (eq_attr "type" "div")
|
|
"i1_pipeline, div*7, div + (port0 | port1)")
|
|
|
|
(define_insn_reservation "float" 3 (eq_attr "type" "float")
|
|
"f_pipeline, nothing, (port0 | port1))
|
|
|
|
(define_bypass 4 "float" "simple,mult,div")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
To simplify the description we could describe the following reservation
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_reservation "finish" "port0|port1")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
and use it in all @code{define_insn_reservation} as in the following
|
|
construction
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
|
|
"(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), finish")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Conditional Execution
|
|
@section Conditional Execution
|
|
@cindex conditional execution
|
|
@cindex predication
|
|
|
|
A number of architectures provide for some form of conditional
|
|
execution, or predication. The hallmark of this feature is the
|
|
ability to nullify most of the instructions in the instruction set.
|
|
When the instruction set is large and not entirely symmetric, it
|
|
can be quite tedious to describe these forms directly in the
|
|
@file{.md} file. An alternative is the @code{define_cond_exec} template.
|
|
|
|
@findex define_cond_exec
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_cond_exec
|
|
[@var{predicate-pattern}]
|
|
"@var{condition}"
|
|
"@var{output-template}")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@var{predicate-pattern} is the condition that must be true for the
|
|
insn to be executed at runtime and should match a relational operator.
|
|
One can use @code{match_operator} to match several relational operators
|
|
at once. Any @code{match_operand} operands must have no more than one
|
|
alternative.
|
|
|
|
@var{condition} is a C expression that must be true for the generated
|
|
pattern to match.
|
|
|
|
@findex current_insn_predicate
|
|
@var{output-template} is a string similar to the @code{define_insn}
|
|
output template (@pxref{Output Template}), except that the @samp{*}
|
|
and @samp{@@} special cases do not apply. This is only useful if the
|
|
assembly text for the predicate is a simple prefix to the main insn.
|
|
In order to handle the general case, there is a global variable
|
|
@code{current_insn_predicate} that will contain the entire predicate
|
|
if the current insn is predicated, and will otherwise be @code{NULL}.
|
|
|
|
When @code{define_cond_exec} is used, an implicit reference to
|
|
the @code{predicable} instruction attribute is made.
|
|
@xref{Insn Attributes}. This attribute must be boolean (i.e.@: have
|
|
exactly two elements in its @var{list-of-values}). Further, it must
|
|
not be used with complex expressions. That is, the default and all
|
|
uses in the insns must be a simple constant, not dependent on the
|
|
alternative or anything else.
|
|
|
|
For each @code{define_insn} for which the @code{predicable}
|
|
attribute is true, a new @code{define_insn} pattern will be
|
|
generated that matches a predicated version of the instruction.
|
|
For example,
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "addsi"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
|
|
(plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
|
|
"@var{test1}"
|
|
"add %2,%1,%0")
|
|
|
|
(define_cond_exec
|
|
[(ne (match_operand:CC 0 "register_operand" "c")
|
|
(const_int 0))]
|
|
"@var{test2}"
|
|
"(%0)")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
generates a new pattern
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(cond_exec
|
|
(ne (match_operand:CC 3 "register_operand" "c") (const_int 0))
|
|
(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
|
|
(plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r"))))]
|
|
"(@var{test2}) && (@var{test1})"
|
|
"(%3) add %2,%1,%0")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Constant Definitions
|
|
@section Constant Definitions
|
|
@cindex constant definitions
|
|
@findex define_constants
|
|
|
|
Using literal constants inside instruction patterns reduces legibility and
|
|
can be a maintenance problem.
|
|
|
|
To overcome this problem, you may use the @code{define_constants}
|
|
expression. It contains a vector of name-value pairs. From that
|
|
point on, wherever any of the names appears in the MD file, it is as
|
|
if the corresponding value had been written instead. You may use
|
|
@code{define_constants} multiple times; each appearance adds more
|
|
constants to the table. It is an error to redefine a constant with
|
|
a different value.
|
|
|
|
To come back to the a29k load multiple example, instead of
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
|
|
(use (reg:SI 179))
|
|
(clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
|
|
""
|
|
"loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
You could write:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_constants [
|
|
(R_BP 177)
|
|
(R_FC 178)
|
|
(R_CR 179)
|
|
(R_Q 180)
|
|
])
|
|
|
|
(define_insn ""
|
|
[(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
|
|
(use (reg:SI R_CR))
|
|
(clobber (reg:SI R_CR))])]
|
|
""
|
|
"loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The constants that are defined with a define_constant are also output
|
|
in the insn-codes.h header file as #defines.
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
@ifset INTERNALS
|
|
@node Macros
|
|
@section Macros
|
|
@cindex macros in @file{.md} files
|
|
|
|
Ports often need to define similar patterns for more than one machine
|
|
mode or for more than one rtx code. GCC provides some simple macro
|
|
facilities to make this process easier.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Mode Macros:: Generating variations of patterns for different modes.
|
|
* Code Macros:: Doing the same for codes.
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Mode Macros
|
|
@subsection Mode Macros
|
|
@cindex mode macros in @file{.md} files
|
|
|
|
Ports often need to define similar patterns for two or more different modes.
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
If a processor has hardware support for both single and double
|
|
floating-point arithmetic, the @code{SFmode} patterns tend to be
|
|
very similar to the @code{DFmode} ones.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
If a port uses @code{SImode} pointers in one configuration and
|
|
@code{DImode} pointers in another, it will usually have very similar
|
|
@code{SImode} and @code{DImode} patterns for manipulating pointers.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Mode macros allow several patterns to be instantiated from one
|
|
@file{.md} file template. They can be used with any type of
|
|
rtx-based construct, such as a @code{define_insn},
|
|
@code{define_split}, or @code{define_peephole2}.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Defining Mode Macros:: Defining a new mode macro.
|
|
* Substitutions:: Combining mode macros with substitutions
|
|
* Examples:: Examples
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Defining Mode Macros
|
|
@subsubsection Defining Mode Macros
|
|
@findex define_mode_macro
|
|
|
|
The syntax for defining a mode macro is:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_mode_macro @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{cond1}") ... (@var{moden} "@var{condn}")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
This allows subsequent @file{.md} file constructs to use the mode suffix
|
|
@code{:@var{name}}. Every construct that does so will be expanded
|
|
@var{n} times, once with every use of @code{:@var{name}} replaced by
|
|
@code{:@var{mode1}}, once with every use replaced by @code{:@var{mode2}},
|
|
and so on. In the expansion for a particular @var{modei}, every
|
|
C condition will also require that @var{condi} be true.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_mode_macro P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
defines a new mode suffix @code{:P}. Every construct that uses
|
|
@code{:P} will be expanded twice, once with every @code{:P} replaced
|
|
by @code{:SI} and once with every @code{:P} replaced by @code{:DI}.
|
|
The @code{:SI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == SImode} and
|
|
the @code{:DI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == DImode}.
|
|
|
|
As with other @file{.md} conditions, an empty string is treated
|
|
as ``always true''. @code{(@var{mode} "")} can also be abbreviated
|
|
to @code{@var{mode}}. For example:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_mode_macro GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
means that the @code{:DI} expansion only applies if @code{TARGET_64BIT}
|
|
but that the @code{:SI} expansion has no such constraint.
|
|
|
|
Macros are applied in the order they are defined. This can be
|
|
significant if two macros are used in a construct that requires
|
|
substitutions. @xref{Substitutions}.
|
|
|
|
@node Substitutions
|
|
@subsubsection Substitution in Mode Macros
|
|
@findex define_mode_attr
|
|
|
|
If an @file{.md} file construct uses mode macros, each version of the
|
|
construct will often need slightly different strings or modes. For
|
|
example:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
When a @code{define_expand} defines several @code{add@var{m}3} patterns
|
|
(@pxref{Standard Names}), each expander will need to use the
|
|
appropriate mode name for @var{m}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
When a @code{define_insn} defines several instruction patterns,
|
|
each instruction will often use a different assembler mnemonic.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
When a @code{define_insn} requires operands with different modes,
|
|
using a macro for one of the operand modes usually requires a specific
|
|
mode for the other operand(s).
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
GCC supports such variations through a system of ``mode attributes''.
|
|
There are two standard attributes: @code{mode}, which is the name of
|
|
the mode in lower case, and @code{MODE}, which is the same thing in
|
|
upper case. You can define other attributes using:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_mode_attr @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{value1}") ... (@var{moden} "@var{valuen}")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
where @var{name} is the name of the attribute and @var{valuei}
|
|
is the value associated with @var{modei}.
|
|
|
|
When GCC replaces some @var{:macro} with @var{:mode}, it will scan
|
|
each string and mode in the pattern for sequences of the form
|
|
@code{<@var{macro}:@var{attr}>}, where @var{attr} is the name of a
|
|
mode attribute. If the attribute is defined for @var{mode}, the whole
|
|
@code{<...>} sequence will be replaced by the appropriate attribute
|
|
value.
|
|
|
|
For example, suppose an @file{.md} file has:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_mode_macro P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
|
|
(define_mode_attr load [(SI "lw") (DI "ld")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
If one of the patterns that uses @code{:P} contains the string
|
|
@code{"<P:load>\t%0,%1"}, the @code{SI} version of that pattern
|
|
will use @code{"lw\t%0,%1"} and the @code{DI} version will use
|
|
@code{"ld\t%0,%1"}.
|
|
|
|
Here is an example of using an attribute for a mode:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_mode_macro LONG [SI DI])
|
|
(define_mode_attr SHORT [(SI "HI") (DI "SI")])
|
|
(define_insn ...
|
|
(sign_extend:LONG (match_operand:<LONG:SHORT> ...)) ...)
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
The @code{@var{macro}:} prefix may be omitted, in which case the
|
|
substitution will be attempted for every macro expansion.
|
|
|
|
@node Examples
|
|
@subsubsection Mode Macro Examples
|
|
|
|
Here is an example from the MIPS port. It defines the following
|
|
modes and attributes (among others):
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_mode_macro GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
|
|
(define_mode_attr d [(SI "") (DI "d")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
and uses the following template to define both @code{subsi3}
|
|
and @code{subdi3}:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "sub<mode>3"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:GPR 0 "register_operand" "=d")
|
|
(minus:GPR (match_operand:GPR 1 "register_operand" "d")
|
|
(match_operand:GPR 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
|
|
""
|
|
"<d>subu\t%0,%1,%2"
|
|
[(set_attr "type" "arith")
|
|
(set_attr "mode" "<MODE>")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
This is exactly equivalent to:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_insn "subsi3"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
|
|
(minus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "d")
|
|
(match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
|
|
""
|
|
"subu\t%0,%1,%2"
|
|
[(set_attr "type" "arith")
|
|
(set_attr "mode" "SI")])
|
|
|
|
(define_insn "subdi3"
|
|
[(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
|
|
(minus:DI (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" "d")
|
|
(match_operand:DI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
|
|
""
|
|
"dsubu\t%0,%1,%2"
|
|
[(set_attr "type" "arith")
|
|
(set_attr "mode" "DI")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@node Code Macros
|
|
@subsection Code Macros
|
|
@cindex code macros in @file{.md} files
|
|
@findex define_code_macro
|
|
@findex define_code_attr
|
|
|
|
Code macros operate in a similar way to mode macros. @xref{Mode Macros}.
|
|
|
|
The construct:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_code_macro @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{cond1}") ... (@var{coden} "@var{condn}")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
defines a pseudo rtx code @var{name} that can be instantiated as
|
|
@var{codei} if condition @var{condi} is true. Each @var{codei}
|
|
must have the same rtx format. @xref{RTL Classes}.
|
|
|
|
As with mode macros, each pattern that uses @var{name} will be
|
|
expanded @var{n} times, once with all uses of @var{name} replaced by
|
|
@var{code1}, once with all uses replaced by @var{code2}, and so on.
|
|
@xref{Defining Mode Macros}.
|
|
|
|
It is possible to define attributes for codes as well as for modes.
|
|
There are two standard code attributes: @code{code}, the name of the
|
|
code in lower case, and @code{CODE}, the name of the code in upper case.
|
|
Other attributes are defined using:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_code_attr @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{value1}") ... (@var{coden} "@var{valuen}")])
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
Here's an example of code macros in action, taken from the MIPS port:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_code_macro any_cond [unordered ordered unlt unge uneq ltgt unle ungt
|
|
eq ne gt ge lt le gtu geu ltu leu])
|
|
|
|
(define_expand "b<code>"
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else (any_cond:CC (cc0)
|
|
(const_int 0))
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
|
|
(pc)))]
|
|
""
|
|
@{
|
|
gen_conditional_branch (operands, <CODE>);
|
|
DONE;
|
|
@})
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
This is equivalent to:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
(define_expand "bunordered"
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else (unordered:CC (cc0)
|
|
(const_int 0))
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
|
|
(pc)))]
|
|
""
|
|
@{
|
|
gen_conditional_branch (operands, UNORDERED);
|
|
DONE;
|
|
@})
|
|
|
|
(define_expand "bordered"
|
|
[(set (pc)
|
|
(if_then_else (ordered:CC (cc0)
|
|
(const_int 0))
|
|
(label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
|
|
(pc)))]
|
|
""
|
|
@{
|
|
gen_conditional_branch (operands, ORDERED);
|
|
DONE;
|
|
@})
|
|
|
|
...
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|